Globus Medical
Annual Report 2023

Plain-text annual report

UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549 FORM 10-K ☒ ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2023 or ☐ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 For the transition period from ______________ to _______________ Commission File No. 001-35621 GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter) DELAWARE (State or other jurisdiction of incorporation or organization) 04-3744954 (I.R.S. Employer Identification No.) 2560 General Armistead Avenue, Audubon, PA 19403 (Address of principal executive offices) (Zip Code) (610) 930-1800 (Registrant’s telephone number, including Area Code) Title of each class Class A Common Stock, par value $.001 per share Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act: Trading Symbol(s) GMED Name of exchange on which registered New York Stock Exchange Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act: Yes ☒ No ☐ Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or Section 15(d) of the Act: Yes ☐ No ☒ Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days: Yes ☒ No ☐ Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit such files): Yes ☒ No ☐ Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, a smaller reporting company or an emerging growth company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer,” “smaller reporting company,” and “emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act: Large Accelerated Filer ☒ Accelerated Filer ☐   Non-accelerated Filer ☐  Smaller Reporting Company ☐  If an emerging growth company, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal control over financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that prepared or issued its audit report. ☒ Emerging Growth Company ☐   If securities are registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Exchange Act, indicate by check mark whether the financial statements of the registrant included in the filing reflect the correction of an error to previously issued financial statements. ☐ Indicate by check mark whether any of those error corrections are restatements that required a recovery analysis of incentive-based compensation received by any of the registrant’s executive officers during the relevant recovery period pursuant to §240.10D-1(b). ☐ Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act): Yes ☐ No ☒ The aggregate market value of the voting and non-voting common equity held by non-affiliates of the registrant, computed by reference to the closing sales price for the registrant’s common stock on the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second quarter, June 30, 2023, as reported on the New York Stock Exchange, was approximately $4.6 billion. Table of Contents The number of shares outstanding of the issuer’s common stock (par value $0.001 per share) as of February 16, 2024 was 135,372,391 shares. DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE Portions of our Proxy Statement for our 2024 Annual Meeting of Stockholders, to be filed within 120 days of December 31, 2023, are incorporated by reference in Part III, Items 10, 11, 12, 13 and 14 herein of this Annual Report. Such Proxy Statement, except for the parts therein which have been specifically incorporated by reference, shall not be deemed “filed” for the purposes of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. 2 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES TABLE OF CONTENTS Item 1. Item 1A. Item 1B. Item 2. Item 3. Item 4. Item 5. Item 7. Item 7A. Item 8. Item 9. Item 9A. Item 9B. Item 9C. Item 10. Item 11. Item 12. Item 13. Item 14. Item 15 Item 16 PART I Business Risk Factors Unresolved Staff Comments Properties Legal Proceedings Mine Safety Disclosures PART II Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure About Market Risk Financial Statements and Supplementary Data Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure Controls and Procedures Other Information Disclosure Regarding Foreign Jurisdictions that Prevent inspections PART III Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance Executive Compensation Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence Principal Accountant Fees and Services PART IV Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules Form 10-K Summary SIGNATURES 3 Page 5 20 46 46 46 46 47 49 59 61 97 97 97 99 99 99 99 99 99 100 105 106 Table of Contents PART I CAUTIONARY NOTE CONCERNING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS This Annual Report on Form 10-K contains forward-looking statements within the meaning of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995, Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”), and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”). All statements other than statements of historical fact are forward-looking statements. We have tried to identify forward-looking statements by using words such as “believe,” “may,” “might,” “could,” “will,” “aim,” “estimate,” “continue,” “anticipate,” “intend,” “expect,” “plan” and similar words. These forward-looking statements are based on our current assumptions, expectations and estimates of future events and trends. Forward- looking statements are only predictions and are subject to many risks, uncertainties and other factors that may affect our businesses and operations and could cause actual results to differ materially from those predicted. These risks and uncertainties include, but are not limited to, the risks and costs associated with the integration of, and our ability to successfully integrate the NuVasive business and Globus Medical, Inc. and to achieve anticipated synergies from the integration, health epidemics, pandemics and similar outbreaks, factors affecting our quarterly results, our ability to manage our growth, our ability to sustain our profitability, demand for our products, our ability to compete successfully (including without limitation our ability to convince surgeons to use our products and our ability to attract and retain sales and other personnel), our ability to rapidly develop and introduce new products, our ability to develop and execute on successful business strategies, our ability to comply with changes and applicable laws and regulations that are applicable to our businesses, our ability to safeguard our intellectual property, our success in defending legal proceedings brought against us, trends in the medical device industry, general economic conditions, and other risks set forth throughout this Annual Report, including under “Item 1. Business,” “Item 1A. Risk Factors,” “Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” and “Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure About Market Risk” and those discussed in other documents we file with the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”). Moreover, we operate in an evolving environment. New risk factors and uncertainties emerge from time to time and it is not possible for us to predict all risk factors and uncertainties, nor can we assess the impact of all factors on our business or the extent to which any factor, or combination of factors, may cause actual results to differ materially from those contained in any forward-looking statements. Given these risks and uncertainties, readers are cautioned not to place undue reliance on any forward-looking statements. Forward-looking statements contained in this Annual Report speak only as of the date of this Annual Report. We undertake no obligation to update any forward-looking statements as a result of new information, events or circumstances or other factors arising or coming to our attention after the date hereof. 4 Table of Contents Item 1. Business Overview Globus Medical, Inc. (together, as applicable, with its consolidated subsidiaries, “Globus,” the “Company,” “we,” “us” or “our”), headquartered in Audubon, Pennsylvania, is a medical device company that develops and commercializes healthcare solutions whose mission is to improve the quality of life of patients with musculoskeletal disorders. Founded in 2003, Globus is committed to medical device innovation and delivering exceptional service to hospitals, ambulatory surgery centers and physicians to advance patient care and improve efficiency. Since inception, Globus has listened to the voice of the surgeon to develop practical solutions and products to help surgeons effectively treat patients and improve lives. Globus is an engineering-driven company with a history of rapidly developing and commercializing advanced products and procedures to address treatment challenges. With over 10 product launches in 2023 and operations across 64 countries worldwide, we offer a comprehensive portfolio of innovative and differentiated technologies that are used to treat a variety of musculoskeletal conditions. Although we manage our business globally within one reportable segment, we separate our products and services into two major categories: Musculoskeletal Solutions and Enabling Technologies. NuVasive Merger On September 1, 2023, pursuant to that certain merger agreement (the “Merger Agreement”) with NuVasive, Inc. (“NuVasive”) and Zebra Merger Sub Inc. (“Merger Sub”), Merger Sub, a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, merged with and into NuVasive, with NuVasive surviving as a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company (the “Merger”). Under the Merger Agreement, each share of common stock, par value $0.001 per share, of NuVasive issued and outstanding immediately prior to the effective time of the Merger (other than certain excluded shares as described in the Merger Agreement) was cancelled and converted into the right to receive 0.75 fully paid and non-assessable shares of Class A common stock of Globus, $0.001 par value per share, and the right to receive cash in lieu of fractional shares. Overall Business Market The primary market for our products is the United States (“U.S.”), where we sell our products through a combination of direct sales representatives employed by us and sales representatives employed by our exclusive independent distributors, who distribute our products on our behalf for a commission that is generally based on a percentage of sales. We believe there is significant opportunity to strengthen our position in the U.S. market by increasing the size of our sales force and continuing to add direct and distributor sales representatives in the future. During the year ended December 31, 2023, international sales accounted for approximately 18.4% of our total sales. Internationally, we sell our products through a combination of direct sales representatives employed by us and exclusive international distributors. We believe there are significant opportunities for us to increase our presence in both existing and new international markets through the continued expansion of our direct and distributor sales forces as well as through the commercialization of additional products. Strategy Our goal is to become the market leader in providing innovative solutions to promote healing in patients with musculoskeletal disorders. To achieve this goal, we employ the following business strategies: (cid:0) Leverage our integrated product development engine. We plan to continue developing new products, using the capabilities of our product development engine. We believe our team-oriented and highly integrated development approach, active surgeon input, and demonstrated performance position us to maintain a rapid rate of new product launches. We launched 10 new products in 2023, in addition to assuming NuVasive’s portfolio of products, which include the X360 portfolio, the C360 portfolio featuring the Simplify Cervical Disc, and the P360 portfolio. We have a range of new products in various stages of development and expect to continue to regularly launch new products. (cid:0) Increase the size, scope and productivity of our exclusive U.S. sales force. We believe there is significant opportunity for us to further penetrate existing markets, and to enter new markets, by increasing the size and geographic scope of our exclusive U.S. sales force for Musculoskeletal Solutions. Through the Merger with NuVasive, we have significantly grown our global sales force. We expect to continue to increase the number of our direct and distributor sales representatives in the U.S., to expand into new geographic territories and to deepen our penetration in existing territories. We will also continue to provide our sales representatives with specialized development programs designed to improve their productivity. 5 Table of Contents (cid:0) Continue to expand into international markets. As of December 31, 2023, we had an existing direct or distributor sales presence in 64 countries outside the U.S. We expect to continue to increase our international presence through the commercialization of additional Musculoskeletal Solutions products in current markets and through the expansion of our international sales force in current and new markets. (cid:0) Pursue strategic acquisitions. In 2017, we acquired KB Medical SA, developer of a computer-assisted robotic guidance system, and in 2018 we acquired Nemaris Inc., a company that markets and develops Surgimap®, a leading surgical planning software platform, to further bolster our efforts to advance surgical procedures through Enabling Technologies. In 2019, we acquired substantially all of the assets of StelKast, Inc., a company that designs, manufactures and distributes orthopedic implants for knee and hip replacement surgeries. During the second quarter of 2020, the Company acquired Synoste Oy, a Finnish engineering company that specializes in the research and development of a limb lengthening system. During the fourth quarter of 2021, the Company acquired Capstone Surgical Technologies, LLC., a company that engages in the business of creating advanced drill and robotic surgery platforms. During the fourth quarter of 2022, the Company acquired the membership interests of Harvest Biologics LLC, which engages in the business of selling systems that produce autologous biologics. In 2023, we acquired NuVasive, a leader in spine technology innovation, with a mission to transform surgery, advance care, and change lives. NuVasive’s less-invasive, procedurally integrated surgical solutions are designed to deliver reproducible and clinically proven outcomes. The procedural portfolio includes surgical access instruments, spinal implants, fixation systems, biologics, software for surgical planning, navigation and imaging solutions, magnetically adjustable implant systems for spine and orthopedics, and intraoperative neuromonitoring (“IONM”) technology and service offerings. The Merger expanded our global commercial reach, increased operational capabilities and enhanced our comprehensive offerings of Musculoskeletal Solutions and Enabling Technologies. We intend to selectively pursue acquisitions and alliances that complement our strategic plan and provide innovative technologies, personnel with significant relevant experience, or increased market penetration. We regularly evaluate possible acquisitions and strategic relationships and believe that our resources and experience make us an attractive acquirer or partner. The Globus Solution We believe that our focus on actively listening and responding to the needs of our customers with high quality solutions separates us from our industry peers. Since 2003 we have introduced many products, including 10 products in 2023, designed for the treatment of musculoskeletal disorders. Given our robust product portfolio of unique and differentiated products, as well as the numerous disruptive products in various stages of development, we believe we are well positioned for growth in the musculoskeletal markets we operate in. We believe that our innovative Musculoskeletal Solutions products, combined with our ability to provide world-class service through a highly trained and exclusive sales force and corporate account management, create significant value for our customers. Product & Service Categories While we group our products and services into two categories, Musculoskeletal Solutions and Enabling Technologies, they are not limited to a particular technology, platform or surgical approach. Instead, our goal is to offer a comprehensive product suite that can be used to safely and effectively treat patients based on their specific anatomy and condition, and is customized to the surgeon’s training and surgical preference. Musculoskeletal Solutions Our Musculoskeletal Solutions consist primarily of implantable devices, biologics, accessories, unique surgical instruments, and neuromonitoring services, used in an expansive range of spinal, orthopedic and neurosurgical procedures. Musculoskeletal disorders are a leading driver of healthcare costs worldwide. Disorders range in severity from mild pain and loss of feeling to extreme pain and paralysis. These disorders are primarily caused by degenerative and congenital conditions, deformity, tumors and traumatic injuries. Treatment alternatives for musculoskeletal disorders range from non- operative conservative therapies to surgical interventions depending on the pathology. Conservative therapies include bed rest, medication, casting, bracing, and physical therapy. When conservative therapies are not indicated, or fail to provide adequate quality of life improvements, surgical interventions may be used. Surgical treatments for musculoskeletal disorders can be instrumented, which include the use of implants, or non-instrumented, which forego the use of hardware but may include biologics. 6 Table of Contents Our broad spectrum of spine products addresses the vast majority of conditions affecting the spine including degenerative conditions, deformity, tumors, and trauma. With 20 years in this competitive market, we provide comprehensive solutions that facilitate both open and minimally invasive surgery (“MIS”) techniques. This includes traditional fusion implants such as pedicle screw and rod systems, plating systems, intervertebral spacers and corpectomy devices. We believe we pioneered innovative expandable solutions for interbody fusion, corpectomy and interspinous fixation that allow intraoperative customization of our devices to the patient’s anatomy, eliminating sequential trialing and potentially saving surgical time. We have also developed treatment options for motion preservation technologies, such as dynamic stabilization, total disc replacement and interspinous distraction devices; as well as interventional solutions to treat vertebral compression fractures. Our biologic solutions include regenerative biologic products such as allografts and synthetic alternatives that are adjunctive treatments typically used in combination with stabilizing implant hardware. Our orthopedic trauma solutions are designed to treat a wide variety of orthopedic fracture patterns and patient anatomies in the upper and lower extremities as well as the hip. Our orthopedic trauma and extremity products, covering four major segments of the orthopedic trauma market: fracture plates, compression screws, intramedullary nails, and external fixation. We began marketing these products in 2018 and intend to grow our presence in this field. Fracture plating includes proximal humerus, distal radius, proximal tibia, distal tibia, distal fibula, distal femur, small fragment, mini-fragment and clavicle plates. Intramedullary nailing includes tibial, trochanteric, and femoral nail systems. Regenerative biologic products such as bone void fillers and allograft struts are used in orthopedic procedures where applicable. Our hip and knee joint solutions for the treatment of degenerative conditions or failed previous reconstruction have a long history of clinical use. Over 13 different implants have been marketed to date, including modular hip stems and acetabular cups for total hip arthroplasty as well as posterior stabilizing and cruciate retaining knee arthroplasty implants. Our neuromonitoring services utilize proprietary software that employs hunting algorithms and graphical user interfaces to provide surgeons with an enhanced and intuitive nerve avoidance system. Through our IONM platforms, we give surgeons the option to connect their instruments to a computer system that provides discrete, real-time, surgeon-directed and surgeon-controlled feedback about the directionality and relative proximity of nerves during surgery. We believe our proprietary IONM platforms are a differentiator in the market and are unique in their ability to provide information about the directionality and proximity of nerves. Our systems analyze and then translate complex neurophysiologic data into simple, useful information to assist the surgeon’s clinical decision-making process. Surgeons can connect certain instruments to our IONM systems, thus creating an interactive set of instruments that better enable the safe navigation through the body’s nerve anatomy during surgery. We provide onsite and remote monitoring of the neurological systems of patients undergoing spinal and brain-related surgeries. Monitoring the health of the nervous system during spinal surgery has been a key component of our strategy of product differentiation since early in our development. Enabling Technologies Our Enabling Technologies are comprised of imaging, navigation and robotics (“INR”) solutions for assisted surgery which are advanced computer-assisted intelligent systems designed to enhance a surgeon’s capabilities, and ultimately improve patient care and reduce radiation exposure for all involved, by streamlining surgical procedures to be safer, less invasive, and more accurate. The market for our Enabling Technologies in spine, cranial and orthopedic surgery is still in the infancy stage and consists primarily of imaging, navigation and robotic systems. In spine, a majority of these technologies are limited to surgical planning and assistance in implant placement for increased accuracy and time savings with less intraoperative radiation exposure to the patient and surgical staff. As our Enabling Technologies become more fully integrated with our Musculoskeletal Solutions, a continued rise in adoption is expected. Furthermore, we believe as new technologies such as augmented reality and artificial intelligence are introduced, Enabling Technologies have the potential to transform the way surgery is performed and most importantly, continue to improve patient outcomes. Our INR solutions include the ExcelsiusGPS® platform which is a robotic guidance and navigation system that supports minimally invasive and open procedures with screw and interbody spacer placement applications. The ExcelsiusGPS® platform has a modular design that we expect will serve as a foundation for future clinical applications using artificial intelligence and augmented reality. Also, in 2018, we acquired Nemaris Inc., the company that developed and marketed Surgimap®, a leading surgical planning software platform. Surgimap®’s intuitive, patient-specific surgical planning and cloud- based infrastructure includes predictive algorithms and visual guides that enable healthcare professionals to plan and simulate surgical treatment of complex deformities. The software also enables medical professionals to share medical imaging technology globally to improve procedural workflow and patient care. In 2022, we launched Excelsius3D™, which when combined with the ExcelsiusGPS® robotic navigation system, provides a superior intraoperative, image-guided robotic navigation solution that is designed to improve implant placement accuracy, lower radiation exposure, and shorten operative times. This highly maneuverable and intuitive imaging platform offers 3 imaging modalities, position memory, and a large field of view. Our innovative Enabling Technologies products offer surgeons more information about patient anatomy and surgical options to help them to make well-informed preoperative and intraoperative surgical decisions. We believe the advantages of pre-planning implant position and viewing implants or instruments relative to patient anatomy during surgery are self-evident, and also create significant secondary gains such as eliminating radiation exposure altogether. 7 Table of Contents Product Development and Research We believe in bringing products to market quickly by reducing the time from product conception to launch. We believe our approach to product development is unique and highly efficient. We employ an integrated team approach to product development involving collaboration among surgeons, our engineers, our dedicated researchers, our highly-skilled machinists, and our regulatory personnel. We believe that this team approach, as well as our extensive in-house facilities, allows us to design, test and obtain regulatory clearance and approvals for our products more effectively. We also believe that our product development engine provides us with a competitive advantage in developing solutions to challenging clinical problems for surgeons and improving outcome for patients. Our product development efforts are supported by our in-house research capabilities. We believe that centralizing and consolidating the critical elements of the product development and commercialization process in one facility allows us to bring products from the concept stage to the market more rapidly. Research resources available in-house include a mechanical testing laboratory, spinal kinematics laboratory, tribology laboratory, cadaveric laboratory, materials characterization laboratory, computational laboratory, and clinical and biomechanical research experts. The markets in which we operate are subject to rapid technological advancements. We must constantly improve existing products and introduce new products in order to continue to succeed. Accordingly, we have made significant investments in our product development and research capabilities. Sales and Marketing We market and sell our products primarily through our exclusive global sales force. As of December 31, 2023, we had a direct or distributor sales presence in the U.S. and in 64 other countries. We have dedicated spinal implant, orthopedic trauma and Enabling Technologies sales teams in place. We sell our hip and knee products primarily through independent sales agents. We expect to continue to increase the number of our direct and distributor sales representatives in each of these areas, both in the U.S. and internationally, to expand into new geographic territories and to deepen our penetration in existing territories. We believe the expansion of our U.S. and international sales forces provides us with significant opportunities for future growth as we continue to penetrate existing geographic markets and enter new ones. Our implant sales representatives are present in the operating room during most surgeries in the U.S. and in many, but not all, of the other countries in which our products are sold. These representatives have the responsibility to confirm that all of the items needed in the surgery are available and are provided sterile or are capable of being sterilized at the hospital. An assortment of sizes and quantities of implants are made available to be able to satisfy varying surgical requirements and patient anatomy, along with numerous surgical instruments and cases needed to safely perform the surgery and implantation. As products are used in surgeries, replacement items are shipped to our sales representatives and hospitals to replenish their supply. Surgeon Training and Education We devote significant resources to training and educating surgeons regarding the safety and reproducibility of our surgical techniques and our procedurally integrated solutions. Our surgeon education and training program integrates surgical training with professional development and enables us to introduce surgeons to our comprehensive portfolio and patented approaches to spine surgery. We offer educational and training courses globally through in- person formats and via virtual content, including virtual conferences and video and social channels, to demonstrate the benefits of our innovative products and procedures. Competition We believe that our significant competitors are Medtronic, DePuy Synthes, Stryker, Zimmer Biomet, and Smith and Nephew. Alphatec Holdings, Orthofix, Integra LifeSciences, ZimVie and other smaller public and private companies are also competitors of ours. At any time, these or other market participants may develop alternative treatments, products or procedures for the treatment of musculoskeletal disorders that compete directly or indirectly with our products. They may also develop and patent processes or products earlier than we can, or obtain regulatory clearance or approvals for competing products more rapidly than we can. We compete in the marketplace to recruit and retain qualified scientific, management, and sales personnel, as well as in acquiring technologies and technology licenses complementary to our products or advantageous to our business. Manufacturing and Supply We have greatly expanded our dedicated in-house manufacturing capabilities. Our implant products are manufactured in our facilities in Eagleville, Pennsylvania, Limerick, Pennsylvania and West Carrollton, Ohio. Most of our regenerative biologic products 8 Table of Contents are processed in our facilities in San Antonio, Texas, and in Audubon, Pennsylvania. The ExcelsiusGPS® robotic guidance and navigation system and Excelsius3D™ imaging system are assembled in our facility in Methuen, Massachusetts. Of our implant and instrument products that are not manufactured in-house, a majority are generally manufactured through a network of third- party suppliers. Our suppliers use high precision, computer-aided manufacturing equipment to manufacture our products. We have focused on developing a strong supplier base as part of our manufacturing strategy. Our relationship with our suppliers enables significant interaction between our design engineers and project managers and the suppliers’ engineers and schedulers to work through issues arising during the entire product development cycle. The majority of our suppliers are domestic, which affords our engineers and other members of our product development team the opportunity to work closely with them to commercialize our products. We select our suppliers carefully and generally use a small number of suppliers for each of our key products for added reliability. Our internal quality assurance group evaluates the potential vendor through a formal vendor approval process before we enter into a relationship with the vendor. Suppliers that meet our internal quality assurance standards are added to our approved supplier list. Supplier performance is maintained and managed through a supplier qualification, performance management and corrective action program intended to ensure that all of our product requirements are met or exceeded. All of our suppliers that provide us with implants are ISO-13485 certified, meaning they meet the International Organization for Standardization (“ISO”) requirements for the manufacture of medical devices. Our outsourcing strategy is targeted at companies that meet U.S. Food and Drug Administration (“FDA”), ISO, and quality standards supported by internal policies and procedures. We currently rely on several tissue banks as suppliers of allograft tissue implants, including for our Osteocel Plus and Osteocel Pro product lines. Like our relationships with our device manufacturing suppliers, we subject our tissue processing suppliers to the same quality criteria in terms of selection, qualification, and verification of processed tissue quality upon receipt of goods, as well as hold them accountable for compliance with FDA regulations, state requirements, and voluntary industry standards (such as those put forward by the American Association of Tissue Banks). We also work with a limited number of suppliers for certain components of our Enabling Technologies and IONM platforms and continue to develop redundancies for critical components within those supply chains. Our quality assurance group conducts periodic audits to ensure continued compliance with our standards. Under our existing contracts with third- party manufacturers, we reserve the right to inspect and assure conformance of each product and product component to our specifications. With every shipment of inventory that we receive, our suppliers provide a certificate of compliance with our quality control standards. Our receiving group also performs inspections, packaging and labeling at one of our facilities. We, and our third-party manufacturers, are subject to the quality system regulations of the FDA, state regulations (such as the regulations promulgated by the California Department of Health Services), and regulations promulgated by foreign regulatory bodies (such as in the European Union). For tissue products, we are FDA registered and licensed in the States of California, Delaware, Florida, Illinois, Maryland, New York, and Oregon. For our device implants and instruments, we are FDA-registered, California-licensed, Conformité Européenne (“CE”)-marked and ISO-certified. CE, an acronym for “Conformité Européenne” or European Conformity, is the registration marking designating that a device can be commercially distributed throughout the European Union (“EU”). Our facilities and the facilities of our third-party manufacturers are subject to periodic announced and unannounced inspections by regulatory authorities, and may undergo compliance inspections conducted by the FDA, state, and/or international regulatory agencies for, among other things, conformance to Quality System Regulations and Current Good Manufacturing Practice requirements as well as separate foreign or international standards. We work closely with our suppliers to ensure that our inventory needs are met while maintaining high quality and reliability. We believe our supplier relationships and facilities will support our capacity needs for the foreseeable future. A majority of our product inventory is held primarily with our sales representatives and at hospitals throughout the U.S. We stock inventory in our warehouse facilities and retain title to consigned inventory which is maintained with our field representatives and hospitals in sufficient quantities so that products are available when needed for surgical procedures. Safety stock levels are determined based on a number of factors, including demand, manufacturing lead times, and quantities required to maintain service levels. Surgical Instrument, Implant Sets and Equipment Sales For many of our customers, we provide surgical instrumentation sets, including both implants and instruments, as well as our IONM systems in a manner tailored to fulfill our customer’s obligations to meet surgery schedules. We do not generally receive separate economic value specific to the surgical instrument sets from the surgeons or hospitals that utilize them. In many cases, once the surgery is finished, the surgical instrument sets are returned to us, and we prepare them for shipment to meet future surgeries. We complement this implant and instrument shipment model with field-based instrument assets. This hybrid strategy is designed to improve customer service, minimize backlogs, increase asset turns, optimize freight costs, and maximize cash flow. Our pool of surgical equipment we make available to hospitals continues to increase as we increase our product offering, expand our distribution 9 Table of Contents channels and increase the market penetration of our products. These surgical instrumentation and implant sets are important to the growth of our business, and we anticipate additional investments in such assets going forward. In certain cases, we will sell either surgical instruments, implant sets or both to our customers. While this does not constitute a material component of our business, as customer penetration and volume increases, these sales of sets allow our customers to increase the amount of surgical volume performed locally. Additionally, we offer flexibility to customers for our capital equipment by offering capital sales and leasing arrangements. We do not have a long history of selling, leasing or servicing capital equipment, but we have invested and intend to continue to invest in building resources and expertise in this area. Selling and leasing of capital equipment do not make up a material portion of our total net sales. Intellectual Property We protect our proprietary rights through a variety of methods. In particular, we rely on patent, trademark, copyright, trade secret and other intellectual property laws and also utilize nondisclosure agreements and other measures to protect our rights. We require our employees, consultants and advisors to execute confidentiality agreements in connection with their employment, consulting or advisory relationships with us. We also require our employees, consultants and advisors who we expect to work on our products to agree to disclose and assign to us all inventions conceived using our property or which relate to our business. Despite measures taken to protect our intellectual property, unauthorized parties may attempt to copy aspects of our products or to obtain and use information that we regard as proprietary. As of December 31, 2023, we owned 2,583 issued U.S. patents (2,547 utility patents; 36 design patents) and had applications pending for 867 U.S. patents (866 utility patents; 1 design patents), and we owned 1,744 issued foreign patents and had applications pending for 502 foreign patents. Our issued patents expired or will expire between March 2015 and November 2043. Our trademark portfolio contains 732 registered trademarks and 196 pending trademarks. Our portfolio includes domestic and foreign trademarks with associated logos and tag lines. Third-Party Coverage and Reimbursement We expect that sales volumes and prices of our Musculoskeletal Solutions products including spinal implant, orthopedic trauma, hip and knee arthroplasty, regenerative biologics, advanced technology products and IONM services may grow to be more dependent on the availability of coverage and reimbursement from third-party payors, such as state and federal programs including Medicare, Medicaid and workers’ compensation as well as private insurance plans including Blue Cross Blue Shield plans and commercial insurers. Reimbursement is dynamic and is contingent on coding for given services or procedures, coverage by third-party payors, and adequate payment for the services or procedures. Physicians, hospital outpatient departments, and ambulatory surgery centers use Current Procedural Terminology (“CPT®”) codes to bill for services and procedures which are established by the American Medical Association (“AMA”). Specialty societies such as the North American Spine Society (“NASS”), the American Association of Neurological Surgeons, and the American Academy of Orthopedic Surgeons provide advice to the AMA CPT® Editorial Panel for developing codes. The availability of existing codes to bill for services and procedures may impact the adoption of technology. The CPT codes, depending on the situation and payor rules, are sometimes billed with billing modifiers that can affect coverage and reimbursement. The Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services (“CMS”) and the National Center for Health Statistics are jointly responsible for overseeing changes and modifications to International Classification of Diseases, Clinical Modification/Procedure Coding System (“ICD-10-CM/PCS”) procedure codes used by all providers including physicians and facilities for reporting patient diagnosis(es) (“ICD-10-CM codes”) and hospitals for reporting inpatient procedures (“ICD-10-PCS codes”). The granularity and specificity of the ICD-10-CM/PCS coding system may impact reimbursement in the future, particularly hospital inpatient reimbursement. Physician and hospital coding is subject to change, which could impact coverage and reimbursement and thus potentially impact physician practice behavior. Independent of coding status, third-party payors may deny coverage based on their own criteria. Payor medical policies vary from payor to payor and contract to contract. There are thousands of payor medical policies which are continually reviewed and revised at the discretion of payors. Payor medical policies may become more restrictive. Payors may deem the clinical efficacy of a device or procedure to be experimental or investigational, not the most cost-effective treatment available, or used for an unapproved indication. Additionally, many private payors use coverage decisions and payment amounts established by CMS for the Medicare program as guidelines in setting their coverage and reimbursement policies. Medicare may establish National Coverage Determinations or Medicare Administrative Contractors may establish Local Coverage Determinations that provide coverage information and determine whether services are reasonable and necessary. As the portion of the U.S. population over the age of 65 and eligible for Medicare continues to grow, we may be more vulnerable to coverage 10 Table of Contents and reimbursement limitations imposed by CMS. National and local coverage policy decisions are subject to unforeseeable change and have the potential to impact physician behavior. We will continue to provide the appropriate and compliant resources to patients, physicians, hospitals, and insurers in order to promote the best patient care, provide clarity regarding coverage and reimbursement policies, and work to reverse any non-coverage policies. However, certain third party payors, large and small, may have policies significantly limiting coverage of, products or services that we offer. We will continue to provide resources to patients, surgeons, hospitals, and insurers in order to ensure optimum patient care and clarity regarding reimbursement and work to remove any and all non-coverage policies. National and regional coverage policy decisions are subject to unforeseeable change and have the potential to impact physician behavior and reimbursement for physician services. We cannot offer definitive timeframes or final outcomes regarding reversal of the coverage-limiting policies, as the process is dictated by the third-party payors. For a discussion of these risks, please see the “Risk Factors” section of this Annual Report. Payment amounts are established by government and private payor programs and are subject to fluctuations, which could impact physician practice behavior. Third-party payors are increasingly challenging the prices charged for a wide range of medical products and services. For federal/state programs, such as Medicaid, coverage and reimbursement differ from state to state. Some state Medicaid programs may not reimburse an adequate amount for the procedures performed with our products, if any payment is made at all. In addition, state-level workers’ compensation coverage and reimbursement vary from state to state. Payment by Medicare and other third-party payors may not be adequate to cover the cost of medical devices used in musculoskeletal procedures. Additionally, more musculoskeletal procedures are being performed in the hospital outpatient and ambulatory surgery center settings, in part due to innovation. Reimbursement levels in the hospital outpatient and ambulatory surgery center settings are typically lower than for the hospital inpatient setting and may not be adequate to cover the cost of innovative and novel medical devices. In international markets, reimbursement and healthcare payment systems vary significantly by country and some countries have instituted price ceilings on specific product lines. There can be no assurance that our products will be accepted by third-party payors, that coverage and reimbursement will be available or, if available, that the third-party payors’ coverage and reimbursement policies will not adversely affect our ability to sell our products profitably. In the U.S., as a result of healthcare reform, third-party payors are increasingly required to demonstrate they can improve quality and reduce costs; we accordingly see an increase in pre-approval/prior authorizations and non-coverage policies citing higher levels of evidence required for medical therapies and technologies. In addition, insured individuals are facing increased premiums and higher out–of-pocket costs for medical coverage, which may lead patients to delay medical treatment. An increasing number of insured individuals receive their medical care through managed care programs, which monitor and often require pre-approval of the services that a member will receive. The percentage of individuals covered by managed care programs is expected to grow in the U.S. over the next decade. We believe that the overall escalating cost of medical products and services has led to, and will continue to lead to, increased pressures on the healthcare industry to reduce the costs of products and services. There can be no assurance that third-party coverage and reimbursement will be available or adequate, or that future legislation, regulation, coding or coverage and reimbursement policies of third-party payors will not adversely affect the demand for our products or our ability to sell these products on a profitable basis. Government Regulation Our business is subject to extensive federal, state, local and foreign laws and regulations. These laws and regulations and their interpretations are subject to change. Our products are medical devices and human tissue products subject to extensive regulation by the FDA and other regulatory bodies both inside and outside of the U.S. Each of these agencies requires us to comply with laws and regulations governing the development, testing, manufacturing, storage, labeling, marketing, sales and distribution of our products. Both federal and state governmental agencies continue to subject the healthcare industry to intense regulatory scrutiny, including heightened civil and criminal enforcement efforts. We believe that we have structured our business operations and relationships with our customers to comply with all applicable legal requirements. However, it is possible that governmental entities or other third parties, including Relators (whistleblowers) who can file complaints on behalf of the government and on their own behalf under the federal False Claims Act (“FCA”), could interpret these laws and our efforts to comply with them differently and assert otherwise. We discuss below the statutes and regulations that are most relevant to our business. 11 Table of Contents U.S. Food and Drug Administration Regulation Our products meet the FDA’s definition of medical devices (per Section 201(h)(1) of the Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act) and human tissue products (under 21 CFR Parts 1270 and 1271 or Public Health Service Act Section 361), each subject to varying regulation(s) by the FDA and other federal, state, local and foreign regulatory bodies. FDA regulations govern, among other things, the following activities that we or our partners perform and will continue to perform: (cid:0) product design and development; (cid:0) product testing, manufacturing and safety; (cid:0) post-market surveillance and reporting; (cid:0) product-labeling; (cid:0) complaint-handling; (cid:0) post-market approval studies; (cid:0) controls for electronic and other radiation emitting products; and (cid:0) product advertising, marketing and promotion. FDA Premarket Clearance and Approval Requirements for Medical Devices Unless an exemption applies (as is usually the case with instruments not intended for implantation), each medical device we wish to introduce within interstate commerce in the U.S. requires pre-authorization by the FDA either via 510(k) clearance, premarket approval (“PMA”), grant of a de novo classification request grant or, in less frequent occasions, via Humanitarian Device Exemption (“HDE”) approval. The FDA classifies medical devices into three classes and devices deemed to pose low or moderate risk are placed in either Class I or II. Unless determined as exempt from premarket notification, Class I and II devices generally require the manufacturer to submit to the FDA a premarket notification seeking permission for commercial distribution, and detailing substantial equivalence to another legally U.S. marketed medical device. This process is known as 510(k) review and if successfully resolved results in issuance of a 510(k) clearance by the FDA. The FDA has identified low risk devices which are exempt from this pre-authorization requirement but are not exempt from Design Controls (compliance to which must be documented internally). Devices deemed by the FDA to pose the greatest risk to patients, such as life-sustaining, life-supporting or implantable devices, and devices deemed not substantially equivalent to a previously cleared 510(k) devices are designated as Class III, which typically requires approval of a PMA application. For novel/unclassified devices not previously formally classified by the FDA with no legally marketed predicate which present low to moderate risk, a risk-based classification determination can be requested in accordance with the de novo classification request process, under which the FDA may determine that the product can be appropriately regulated as a Class I or II device and “granted” authorization for commercialization within the U.S. For novel/unclassified devices not previously formally classified by the FDA with no legally marketed predicate intended to treat or diagnose a disease or condition that affects fewer than 8,000 individuals per year in the U.S., the FDA requires adherence to the HDE program. This requires a Humanitarian Use Designation (“HUD”); if the FDA approves the HUD, manufacturers should then seek FDA approval on an Investigational Device Exemption (“IDE”) to collect the necessary human clinical data to support approval of the HDE application. 510(k) premarket notifications, de novo requests, and PMAs are subject to the payment of user fees, paid at the time of submission for FDA review. The FDA can also impose restrictions on the sale, distribution or use of devices at the time of their clearance, approval or grant, or subsequent to marketing. IDEs, PMAs and HDEs most often have post-approval obligations to the FDA and to participating clinical sites, including but not limited to: continued follow-up of enrolled / implanted investigational patients, periodic annual clinical reporting, site monitoring and oversight of on-going Institutional Review Board compliance. Since the Institute of Medicine published their review of the predicated 510(k) review process in 2010, the FDA has continually worked to strengthen and modernize the 510(k) Program. The FDA continues to improve the program through policies which clarify the FDA’s expectations for the content of filings, establishment of alternative pathways to a Traditional 510(k) (known as the Safety and Performance Based pathway), and through the issuance of numerous draft guidance. This evolution has impacted the ability of medical device manufacturers to obtain or maintain 510(k) clearance for devices by both driving clarity and incentivizing the development of safer, more effective devices. Manufacturers must continue to demonstrate their product’s same / superior performance to existing devices more readily & extensively. Among other initiatives, the FDA promotes the use of a best-practice approach as it relates to predicate devices with a long-established history of safe and effective use as opposed to simply accepting reliance on older predicate devices for purposes of comparison in new device 510(k) clearance submissions. If a manufacturer cannot establish that a new or modified product is substantially equivalent to a predicate device, it may be required to seek premarket approval through the PMA or de novo process (the latter only for new products). There are numerous increased burdens associated with the PMA process, which typically requires conduct and submission of human clinical trials with high costs and uncertain outcomes. 12 Table of Contents FDA Postmarket Requirements Pursuant to FDA regulations, we can only market our medical devices for cleared, approved, or granted uses. Although surgeons are permitted to use medical devices for indications other than those cleared, approved or granted by the FDA based on their medical judgment, manufacturers are prohibited from marketing or promoting products for uses which differ from those deemed acceptable through respective 510(k) clearance, de novo grants, or PMA/HDE approvals. Use of our medical devices in a manner different or inconsistent than those detailed within our labeling is considered an “off- label” use. After a medical device is placed in the U.S. market, numerous regulatory requirements continue to apply. These regulatory requirements could include, but are not limited to: (cid:0) device listing and establishment registration; (cid:0) adherence to the Quality System Regulation (per 21 CFR Part 820) (“QSR”) and the newly published Quality Management System Regulation (effective February 2, 2026) which requires stringent design, testing, control, documentation and other quality assurance procedures; (cid:0) labeling requirements and FDA prohibitions against the promotion of off-label uses or indications; (cid:0) adverse event reporting (Manufacturer and User Facility Device Experience); (cid:0) post-approval restrictions or conditions, which could include post-approval clinical trials or other required testing and periodic reporting; (cid:0) post-market surveillance requirements; (cid:0) the FDA’s recall authority, whereby it can ask for, or require, the recall of products from the market (see FDA Enforcement section below); and (cid:0) requirements relating to voluntary corrections or removals. Failure to comply with applicable regulatory requirements can result in fines and other enforcement actions by the FDA, which could adversely impact our business. Human Cell, Tissue and Cellular and Tissue-Based Products We currently distribute a number of products processed from human tissue, some of which are manufactured by third-party suppliers. The FDA regulates human tissue products as Human Cells and Cellular and Tissue-Based Products (“HCT/Ps”). Certain HCT/Ps are regulated solely under Section 361 of the Public Health Service Act and are referred to as “Section 361 HCT/Ps,” while other HCT/Ps are subject to the FDA’s regulatory requirements for medical devices or biologics under 21 CFR Parts 1270 and 1271. Section 361 HCT/Ps do not require premarket authorization (510(k) clearance, PMA approval, or other pre-market approvals) from the FDA before marketing. Tissue banks that handle HCT/Ps must register their establishments with the FDA, list their HCT/P products with the FDA, and comply with FDA donor eligibility and screening requirements, current Good Tissue Practice (“CGTP”), Cellular- and Tissue-Based Product Establishments, product labeling, and postmarket reporting requirements for HCT/Ps. The FDA and other state and regional agencies periodically inspect tissue processors to determine compliance with these requirements. Entities that provide us with allograft bone tissue are responsible for performing donor recovery, donor screening and donor testing and our compliance with those aspects of the CGTP regulations that regulate those functions are dependent upon the actions of these independent entities. The procurement and transplantation of allograft bone tissue is subject to U.S. federal law pursuant to the National Organ Transplant Act (“NOTA”), a criminal statute which prohibits the purchase and sale of human organs used in human transplantation, including bone and related tissue, for “valuable consideration.” NOTA permits reasonable payments associated with the removal, transportation, processing, preservation, quality control, implantation and storage of human bone tissue. With the exception of removal and implantation, we provide services in all of these areas. The procurement of human tissue is also subject to state anatomical gift acts and some states have statutes similar to NOTA. In addition, some states require that tissue processors be licensed by that state. FDA Enforcement The FDA enforces these requirements (for both medical device and human tissue products) by inspection and routine market surveillance. Failure to comply with applicable regulatory requirements can result in enforcement action by the FDA, which may include any of the following sanctions: (cid:0) untitled letters or formal warning letters; (cid:0) fines, injunctions and civil penalties; (cid:0) recall or seizure of our products; 13 Table of Contents (cid:0) operating restrictions, partial suspension or total shutdown of production; (cid:0) refusing our request for review of 510(k), de novo, or PMA of new products; (cid:0) withdrawal of 510(k) clearance(s), de novo grant(s), or PMA approval(s) that are already issued; (cid:0) refusal to grant export approval of our products; and (cid:0) criminal prosecution. Failure to comply with applicable regulatory requirements can result in fines and other enforcement actions by the FDA, which could adversely impact our business. We are subject to both announced and unannounced inspections (device and tissue) by the FDA’s Office of Regulatory Affairs, Office of Compliance, Center for Devices and Radiological Health, Center for Biologics Evaluation and Research, and American Association of Tissue Banks, as well as other regulatory agencies overseeing the implementation and adherence of applicable state and federal tissue licensing regulations. These inspections may include our manufacturing, suppliers’ and sub-contractors’ facilities. On October 31, 2018, we received a warning letter from the FDA resulting from an inspection of the facilities of our subsidiary Human Biologics of Texas, located in San Antonio, Texas, in April 2018. The letter described observed non-conformities to regulations for human cells, tissues, and cellular and tissue-based products relating to one allograft tissue product processed by Human Biologics of Texas and sold to end users. We took the matters identified in the warning letter seriously and worked diligently to address the FDA’s observations. We responded to the FDA’s warning letter on November 20, 2018, provided periodic updates to the FDA on our progress, and notified the FDA of actions completed to resolve the observations. As of December 31, 2023, this warning letter has been resolved. State-Level Requirements While the FDA regulates the inter-state distribution and commerce of medical devices and tissue products within the U.S. (as outlined above), there are a number of states with specific regional registration requirements. We are obligated to comply with state-level requirements and register ourselves as a medical device wholesaler and human tissue processor. States with such registration requirements include but are not limited to: Illinois, Connecticut, Oregon, Delaware, California, Louisiana, and Pennsylvania. These state-level agencies have varying requirements which may require annual obligations and can result in periodic inspection by respective Health Departments. International International sales of medical devices are subject to foreign government regulations, which vary substantially from country to country. In order to market our products in other countries, we must obtain regulatory approvals and comply with extensive country-specific device safety and quality regulations. The time required to obtain approval by a foreign country may be longer or shorter than that required for FDA clearance, approval or grant, and the requirements may differ. The EU/European Economic Area (“EEA”) requires a CE mark in order to place medical devices “in market”. Many other countries, such as Australia, India, New Zealand, Pakistan and Sri Lanka, accept CE or FDA authorizations (clearance, approval or grant). Other countries, such as Brazil, Canada, Switzerland and Japan, require separate region-specific regulatory filings. In the EEA, our devices are required to comply with the essential requirements of the EU Medical Device Directive (Council Directive 93/42/EEC) (“MDD”). Compliance with these requirements entitles us to affix the CE conformity mark to our medical devices, without which medical devices cannot be commercialized in the EEA. To demonstrate compliance with the essential requirements and obtain the right to affix the CE conformity mark we must undergo a conformity assessment procedure, which varies according to the type of medical device and its classification. The method of assessing conformity varies depending on the classification of the product, but typically involves a combination of self-assessment by the manufacturer and a third-party assessment by an accredited “Notified Body”. This third-party assessment consists of an audit of the manufacturer’s quality system and technical review of the manufacturer’s product. The EU has also adopted the EU Medical Device Regulation (“MDR”), which replaced existing directives and imposes stricter requirements for the marketing and sale of medical devices, including new clinical evaluation, quality system, and post-market surveillance requirements. Following the expiration of the transitional provisions of the MDD relating to the CE mark (extended to December 2027), all medical device companies intending to manufacture and/or market products in the EEA after May 2024, including Globus Medical, NuVasive and NuVasive Specialized Orthopedics), will be required to comply with requirements of the MDR EU 2017/745, which increased technical documentation requirements, imparted more labeling obligations of higher risk devices, and altered the classification of some of our products. Most devices that are CE-marked under the MDD may continue to be marketed in the EU under certain conditions until December 2027 for Class III and IIb devices; 2028 for Class II and class I devices which require involvement of a Notified Body in the conformity assessment, at which time these products must comply with the new regulation. MDD compliant products intended to be placed on the market after May 2024 must meet certain conditions and be under contract with an MDR accredited Notified Body and in compliance with Transitional Provisions. 14 Table of Contents Additionally, in the EEA the procurement, testing, processing, preservation, storage and distribution of human tissues and cells is subject to the requirements of the laws of individual EEA Member States implementing Directive 2004/23/EC, Directive 2006/17/EC and Directive 2006/86/EC. Further, the advertising and promotion of our products in the EEA is subject to limited provisions under Regulation 2017/745 and the laws of individual EEA Member States implementing Directive 2006/114/EC concerning misleading and comparative advertising, and Directive 2005/29/EC on unfair commercial practices, as well as other EEA Member State laws and industry codes governing the advertising and promotion of medical devices. These laws and codes may limit or restrict the advertising and promotion of our products to the general public and may impose limitations on our promotional activities with healthcare professionals. In addition to the presiding MDD (93/42/EEC; MDD) and MDR (2017/745; MDR) outlined above, we must also comply with EU / EEA laws, directives, regulations and recognized standards as applicable to the devices we produce. These requirements can include all facets of healthcare, including environmental compliance, product stewardship, technical considerations, material of manufacture, and labeling availability. Below is a non-exhaustive list of requirements to apply to devices within our portfolio and to which we must demonstrate some degree of compliance: (cid:0) Regulation (EC) No 1907/2006 of the European Parliament and of the Council of 18 December 2006 concerning the Registration, Evaluation, Authorization and Restriction of Chemicals; (cid:0) Directive 2011/65/EU of the European Parliament and of the Council of 8 June 2011 on the restriction of the use of certain hazardous substances in electrical and electronic equipment (recast); (cid:0) Directive 2012/19/EU of the European Parliament and of the Council of 4 July 2012 on waste electrical and electronic equipment; (cid:0) Commission Implementing Regulation (EU) 2021/2226 of 14 December 2021 laying down rules for the application of Regulation (EU) 2017/745 of the European Parliament and of the Council as regards electronic instructions for use of medical devices; (cid:0) Directive (EU) 2023/2413 of the European Parliament and of the Council of 18 October 2023 amending Directive (EU) 2018/2001, Regulation (EU) 2018/1999 and Directive 98/70/EC as regards the promotion of energy from renewable sources, and repealing Council Directive (EU) 2015/652; (cid:0) Directive 2014/30/EU of the European Parliament and the Council of 26 February 2014 on the harmonization of the laws of the Member States relating to electromagnetic compatibility; (cid:0) Directive 2006/66/EC of the European Parliament and of the Council of 6 September 2006 on batteries and accumulators and waste batteries and accumulators and repealing Directive 91/157/EEC; and (cid:0) Directive 94/62/EC of 20 December 1994 on packaging and packaging waste. In addition to compliance with EU & EEA statutes, we must also comply with national laws of individual sovereign nations (i.e. Member States). These laws vary and can include additional registration efforts to be completed before CE -marked product can be distributed within respective Member States. Following a national referendum and enactment of legislation by the government of the United Kingdom (“UK”), the UK formally withdrew from the EU and ratified a trade and cooperation agreement governing its future relationship with the EU. The agreement addresses trade, economic arrangements, law enforcement, judicial cooperation, and a governance framework, including procedures for dispute resolution, among other things. Because the agreement merely sets forth a framework in many respects and will require complex additional bilateral negotiations between the UK and the EU, significant political and economic uncertainty remains about how the precise terms of the relationship between the parties will differ from the terms before withdrawal. Further, pursuant to guidance issued by the UK Government, the Medicines and Healthcare products Regulatory Agency (“MHRA”) became the standalone medicines and medical devices regulator for the UK as of January 1, 2021. A new mark, UK Conformity Assessed (“UKCA”), has also been introduced and will replace the CE conformity mark in the UK. UK-approved Notified Bodies designated by the MHRA will conduct conformity assessments against applicable requirements of the UKCA mark. Obtaining the UKCA conformity mark is optional from January 2021 and will have rolling requirements for MDD/MDR certified devices through 2027. Although CE conformity marking and certificates issued by Notified Bodies will continue to be recognized in the UK through 2027, all medical devices were required to be registered with the MHRA as of January 1, 2021 in accordance with the provided grace period depending on the product risk classification. This grace period has been extended, and the UK Parliament intends to bring forward an additional statutory instrument to legislate for further measures in Spring 2024. Additionally, for manufacturers based outside of the UK, a single UK Responsible Person with a place of business in the UK must be established. Complying with this new regulatory framework will require us to invest in additional resources and could be expensive, time-consuming and disruptive to our existing operations in the UK. In 2014, the Japanese government revised the Pharmaceutical Affairs Law, now the Pharmaceutical and Medical Device Act (“PMD Act”), which made significant changes to the pre-approval regulatory systems. These changes have, in part, stipulated that, in addition to obtaining a manufacturing or import approval from the Ministry of Health, Labor and Welfare, certain low-risk medical devices can now be evaluated by third-party organizations. Based on the risk-based classification, manufacturers are provided three 15 Table of Contents procedures for satisfying the PMD Act requirements prior to placing products on the market: Premarket Submission, Premarket Certification, and Premarket Approval. Devices marketed in Japan must comply with the PMD Act, MO169, 2021 and are assessed by both government entities and third- party organizations using all three procedures in place for manufacturers. The level of review and timeline for medical device approval depends on the risk- based classification and subsequent regulatory procedure that the medical device is aligned based on assessment against the current PMD Act. Manufacturers must also obtain a manufacturing or import license from the prefectural government prior to importing medical devices; manufacturers should also expect an inspection by the government agency. We also pursue authorizations required by the prefectural government as required. Device and tissue pre-market approval, registration. and facility licensing requirements also exist in other markets where international facilities are established and where we may conduct business, including, but not limited to, Southeast Asia, Australia, and Latin America. Such requirements vary by country and Globus Medical & all its subsidiaries have established procedures to drive its compliance with these requirements. Data protection laws, including the EU General Data Protection Regulation (“GDPR”), also apply to our international operations. The GDPR requires, among other things, obligations and restrictions on the ability to collect, analyze and transfer EU personal data and the prompt notice of data breaches to data subjects and supervisory authorities in certain circumstances. These data protection regulations create a range of compliance obligations and authorize substantial fines for non-compliance. We are subject to announced and unannounced device inspections by Notified Bodies (an organization accredited by a Member State of the EEA to conduct conformity assessments), as well as other regulatory agencies overseeing the implementation and adherence of applicable regulations. These inspections may include our suppliers’ facilities. Sales and Marketing Commercial Compliance Federal anti-kickback laws and regulations prohibit, among other things, persons from knowingly and willfully soliciting, receiving, offering or paying remuneration, directly or indirectly, in exchange for, to induce or to reward either the referral of an individual, or the purchase, order or recommendation of, any good or service paid for under federal healthcare programs such as the Medicare and Medicaid programs. The term “remuneration” has been interpreted broadly to include anything of value. State anti-kickback laws have similar prohibitions. Federal false claims laws prohibit any person from knowingly presenting, or causing to be presented, a false or fraudulent claim for payment to the federal government; knowingly making, or causing to be made, a false statement to get a false claim paid; or knowingly avoiding, decreasing or concealing an obligation to pay money to the federal government. Violations of the federal Anti-Kickback Statute and off-label promotion have been pursued by the Department of Justice (“DOJ”) and the Department of Health and Human Services (“HHS”) as violations of the federal civil False Claims Act (“FCA”). Intent to deceive is not required to establish liability under the civil False Claims Act. Rather, a claim may be false for deliberate ignorance of the truth or falsity of the information provided or for acts in reckless disregard of the truth or falsity of that information. Lawsuits under the FCA often are initiated by Relators on behalf of the government. Relators are incentivized to pursue claims against manufacturers and providers by the potential to share in any monetary recoveries by the government in litigation or as part of a settlement, which can be significant. In addition, private payers have been filing follow- on lawsuits alleging fraudulent misrepresentation, although establishing liability and damages in these cases is more difficult than under the FCA. Pursuant to FDA regulations, we can only market our products for cleared or approved uses. Although surgeons are permitted to use medical devices for indications other than those cleared or approved by the FDA based on their medical judgment, we are prohibited from promoting products for such off-label uses. Legislation periodically is introduced in the United States Congress that would broaden the applicability of the FCA and implement other changes that would not be favorable to defendants in FCA cases. If enacted, such legislation could apply to any case filed under the FCA on or after the date of enactment. Additionally, the majority of states in which we market our products have similar anti-kickback, false claims, anti-fee splitting and physician self-referral laws, which may apply to items or services reimbursed by any third-party payor, including commercial insurers, and violations may result in substantial civil and criminal sanctions. Other federal statutes pertaining to healthcare fraud and abuse include the civil monetary penalties statute, which prohibits, among other things, the offer or payment of remuneration to a Medicaid or Medicare beneficiary that the offeror or payor knows or should know is likely to influence the beneficiary to order a receive a reimbursable item or service from a particular supplier, and the additional federal criminal statutes created by the Health Insurance Portability and Accountability Act of 1996, as amended (“HIPAA”), which prohibits, among other things, knowingly and willfully executing or attempting to execute a scheme to defraud any healthcare benefit program or obtain by means of false or fraudulent pretenses, representations or promises any money or property owned by or under the control of any healthcare benefit program in connection with the delivery of or payment for healthcare benefits, items or services. 16 Table of Contents Also under HIPAA, a Covered Entity is required to adhere to certain requirements regarding the use, disclosure and security of protected health information (“PHI”). In the past, HIPAA has generally affected us indirectly, as Globus is generally neither a Covered Entity nor a Business Associate, as further defined under HIPAA, to Covered Entities, except that our provision of IONM services through various subsidiaries may create a Business Associate relationship; additionally, we treat our IONM service business and Puerto Rico subsidiary as a Covered Entity. Regardless of Covered Entity status under HIPAA, in those cases where patient data is received, Globus is committed to maintaining the security and privacy of PHI. The potential for enforcement action against us is now greater, as HHS can take action directly against Business Associates. Thus, while we believe we are and will continue to be in compliance with all required HIPAA standards, there is no guarantee that HHS will agree. Enforcement actions can be costly and interrupt regular operations of our business. The Physician Payments Sunshine Act of 2009 (the "Sunshine Act”) was enacted into law in 2010 and requires public disclosure to the U.S. government of certain payments and other transfers of value to U.S.-licensed physicians, physician assistants, nurse practitioners, clinical nurse specialists, certified registered nurse anesthetists and anesthesiologist assistants, nurse midwives, and teaching hospitals, including in-kind transfers of value such as educational items or meals. Ownership and investment interests by physicians and their immediate family members also must be reported. The Sunshine Act also provides penalties for non-compliance. The Sunshine Act requires that we file an annual report on March 31 of a calendar year for the transfers of value incurred for the prior calendar year. This law, along with various international and individual state reporting, compliance program, gift ban and marketing program requirements, such as in Massachusetts and Vermont, increases the possibility that a healthcare company may run afoul of one or more of the requirements. The U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act (“FCPA”) and similar anti-bribery laws in non-U.S. jurisdictions, such as the UK’s Bribery Act, generally prohibit companies and their intermediaries from making improper payments to non-U.S. government officials and (in the case of the Bribery Act) private sector decision makers for the purpose of obtaining or retaining business. Because of the predominance of government-owned or-administered healthcare systems in many jurisdictions around the world, many of our customer relationships outside of the U.S. are with governmental entities and are therefore potentially subject to such laws. Global enforcement of anti-corruption laws has increased considerably in recent years, with more frequent voluntary self- disclosures by companies, aggressive investigations and enforcement proceedings by U.S. and non-U.S. governmental agencies, and assessment of significant fines and penalties against companies and individuals. It is our policy to implement safeguards to educate our employees and agents on these legal requirements and prohibit improper practices. The government may seek to hold us liable for FCPA violations committed by companies that we acquire. Violations of these laws may be punishable by criminal or civil sanctions, including substantial fines, imprisonment of current or former employees and exclusion from participation in governmental healthcare programs. Additionally, we must comply with a variety of other laws that protect the privacy of individually identifiable healthcare information and impose extensive tracking and reporting related to transfers of value provided to certain healthcare professionals. Environmental Matters The manufacture of certain of our products, including our allograft implants and products, and the handling of materials used in the product testing process, including in our cadaveric laboratory, involve the controlled use of biological, hazardous and/or radioactive materials and wastes. Our business and facilities and those of our suppliers are subject to foreign, federal, state and local laws and regulations relating to the protection of human health and the environment, including those governing the use, manufacture, storage, handling and disposal of, and exposure to, such materials and wastes. In addition, under some environmental laws and regulations, we could be held responsible for costs relating to any contamination at our past or present facilities and at third-party waste disposal sites even if such contamination was not caused by us. We are not currently aware of any material costs or liabilities relating to environmental matters, including any claims or actions under environmental laws or obligations to perform any cleanups at any of our facilities or any third-party waste disposal sites that we expect to have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition or operating results. However, it is possible that material environmental costs or liabilities may arise in the future. Human Capital Workforce Overview We believe our employees are our most valuable asset and are critical to our success as an organization. Our talent-related initiatives, including employee recruitment and development, compensation and benefit programs, are focused on building and retaining the world-class and talented staff that is needed to meet our goals. As of December 31, 2023, we had over 5,000 employees worldwide, including sales and marketing, product development, general administrative and accounting, both domestically and internationally. Our employees are not subject to a collective bargaining agreement except in a single market outside the U.S., and we consider our relationship with our employees to be good. 17 Table of Contents Compensation and Benefits We offer competitive benefit packages, supporting our employees as they help create a leading, global musculoskeletal technology company. This includes encouraging a culture of health by providing benefits programs to best serve our employees and their family members. Our comprehensive benefits package may include competitive pay, annual incentive awards and bonus opportunities, health and wellness programs, healthcare and retirement benefits, and paid time off and sick leave. Talent Development We believe that success comes from investing in our people and ensuring our workforce is aligned with our mission and values. To achieve this goal, we devote time and resources to assist our employees in being familiar with our business, industry, and product offerings. We have developed a robust onboarding program for our newly hired associates that provides a comprehensive overview of our product portfolio and company history. We put an emphasis on training our employees and sales representatives to understand our business, including the underlying medical conditions that our products treat. In addition, we strive to support our teams in the areas of professional development, mentoring, engagement, and health and wellness, enabling them to do their best work as they grow their careers. Employees are encouraged to partner with their manager to create individual plans to guide their development path and to incorporate training offerings and resources to support their growth and drive their continued success. Additionally, we regularly conduct talent reviews and succession planning to identify and develop our current and future leaders. We are committed to identifying and developing talent to help those employees accelerate their growth and achieve their career goals. Employee Engagement and Communication Our success depends on our employees understanding our strategy as well as our annual goals and priorities. This is accomplished through a number of channels, including a global intranet and sales enablement platform, regional and functional meetings, and quarterly updates in global Town Halls with leadership. We value open and direct communication with our employees about their experiences. We use a variety of channels to obtain employee feedback, including employee surveys, open forums with leadership, and an employee resource group. Our annual employee engagement survey provides us with actionable data for the overall company and each department and also provides managers with upward feedback on how they are progressing against expectations. Each year, the input received through these mechanisms is used to help strengthen our culture and improve employee engagement. Diversity and Inclusion We recognize the value associated with fostering a work environment that is culturally diverse and inclusive and believe that diverse teams stimulate innovation, enhance our understanding of the needs of our customers, and ultimately deliver better results for our stakeholders. As of December 31, 2023, our Board of Directors consisted of eleven members, two of whom identified as female and two of whom identified as having a racial and ethnic background other than white. Our goal is to cultivate a respectful and professional environment where all voices are heard and valued. Our HR and talent teams create professional development opportunities for employees of all genders, ethnicities and minority groups, backgrounds, experience levels, and locations. As we seek to create a more diverse and inclusive workforce, we monitor voluntarily disclosed diversity data to review hiring, promotion and attrition overall at the Company and at the department level. We also review performance data and promotion and compensation information to ensure fair and objective decision-making. We believe that building diverse teams and leveraging broad perspectives will empower our employees and strengthen our ability to meet the needs of our customers, patients, and communities we serve. Health, Safety, and Wellness We are committed to the protection of our employees, customers, communities and the environment. Our key areas of focus include corporate compliance with responsible hazardous waste management, recycling, emergency preparedness, as well as various initiatives to improve our health and safety programs with the goal of reducing and ultimately eliminating serious injuries. Our Environmental, Health & Safety personnel develop global safety practices and procedures, train employees, host annual safety campaigns, and monitor compliance with safety procedures. Community Our employees and sales representatives have a long history of providing support and care to our communities, donating time, resources and funds to local causes. Since 2009, we have leveraged our expertise in spine care to give back to local and global communities through Globus Cares and NuVasive Spine Foundation, both 501(c)(3) nonprofit organizations. These organizations support life-changing spine surgery for individuals around the world with limited access to high quality medical treatment by working with surgeons to advance the quality of spine care in disadvantaged communities. In addition, through our grants program, we support 18 Table of Contents medical research and education, charitable and philanthropic endeavors. We believe in giving back, and we also believe it is important to operate our company in a socially responsible manner. Information We were incorporated in Delaware in March 2003. Our principal executive offices are located at 2560 General Armistead Avenue, Audubon, Pennsylvania 19403, and our telephone number at that location is (610) 930-1800. Our corporate website address is http://www.globusmedical.com. The information contained in or accessible through our website or contained on other websites is not deemed to be part of this Annual Report on Form 10-K. We are subject to the filing requirements of the Exchange Act. Therefore, we file annual reports, periodic reports, proxy statements and other information with the SEC. The SEC maintains a website (www.sec.gov) that contains reports, proxy and information statements, and other information regarding issuers that file electronically. We make our annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q, current reports on Form 8-K and all amendments to such reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Exchange Act available free of charge through a link on the Investors section of our website located at http://www.globusmedical.com (under “SEC Filings”) as soon as reasonably practicable after they are filed with or furnished to the SEC. 19 Table of Contents Item 1A. Risk Factors Risk factors that could cause our actual results to differ from our expectations and that could negatively impact our business, results of operations and financial condition are discussed below and elsewhere in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. If any of these risks actually occurs, our business, results of operations, financial condition and future growth prospects could be materially and adversely affected. You should carefully read and consider each of these risks, together with all of the other information set forth in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. The risks and uncertainties described below are not the only ones we face. Additional risks and uncertainties not presently known to us or that we currently believe are immaterial may also materially adversely affect our business, results of operations, financial condition and future growth prospects, and our stock price. We are providing the following summary of the risk factors contained in our Form 10-K to enhance the readability and accessibility of our risk factor disclosures. We encourage our stockholders to carefully review the full risk factors contained in this Form 10-K in their entirety for additional information regarding the risks and uncertainties that could cause our actual results to vary materially from recent results or from our anticipated future results. Risks Related to Our Business and Our Industry (cid:0) To be commercially successful, we must convince surgeons and hospitals that our products are an attractive alternative to our competitors’ products and to existing surgical treatments of musculoskeletal disorders. (cid:0) Pricing pressure from our competitors and our customers may impact our ability to sell our products profitably. (cid:0) If our customers are unable to obtain adequate coverage and reimbursement for their purchases of our products, we may not be able to sell them profitably. (cid:0) If we are unable to maintain and expand our network of direct sales representatives and independent distributors, we may not be able to generate anticipated sales. (cid:0) Our sales and operating results may be negatively affected and we may not grow if we are unable to compete successfully. (cid:0) We are dependent on a limited number of third-party suppliers, and the loss of any of these suppliers, or their inability to provide us with an adequate supply of products or materials in a timely manner could harm our business. (cid:0) The proliferation of physician-owned distributorships (“PODs”) could result in increased pricing pressure on our products or harm our ability to sell our products to physicians. (cid:0) Our business could suffer if we lose the services of key members of our senior management, advisors or personnel. (cid:0) The safety and efficacy of our products is not yet supported by long-term clinical data. (cid:0) If we do not enhance our product offerings and introduce new products, we may be unable to effectively compete. (cid:0) We are subject to risks arising from our acquisitions of or investments in new or complementary businesses, products or technologies. (cid:0) We are required to maintain high levels of inventory, which may be costly. (cid:0) We rely on information technology systems and network infrastructure to operate and manage our business, which may be subject to a breach, cyber-attack or other disruption. (cid:0) We are subject to data privacy laws and our failure to comply with them could subject us to substantial liabilities. (cid:0) If we experience significant disruptions in our information technology systems, our business, results of operations and financial condition could be adversely affected. (cid:0) Consolidation in the healthcare industry could lead to demands for price concessions or to the exclusion of some suppliers from certain of our markets, which could have an adverse effect on our business. (cid:0) If our Enabling Technologies products require significant amounts of service after sale or we receive a significant number of warranty claims, our costs may increase. (cid:0) We experience long and variable capital sales cycles for our Enabling Technologies products. (cid:0) Certain contractual counterparties may seek to modify contractual relationships with the Company, which could have an adverse effect on the Company’s business and operations. (cid:0) The Company may be exposed to increased litigation, which could have an adverse effect on the Company’s business and operations. (cid:0) Our IONM business exposes us to risks inherent with the sale of services. 20 Table of Contents Risks Related to our Legal and Regulatory Environment (cid:0) Our medical device products and operations are subject to extensive governmental regulation both in the U.S. and abroad. (cid:0) Modifications to our products may require new 510(k) or de novo clearances, PMAs or PMA supplements. (cid:0) Our HCT/P products are subject to extensive government regulation. (cid:0) We and our suppliers are subject to the FDA’s good manufacturing practice regulations and similar international regulations. (cid:0) We may be subject to a recall of our products or the discovery of serious safety issues with our products. (cid:0) We may be subject to enforcement action if we engage in the off-label promotion of our products. (cid:0) Governmental regulation and limited sources and suppliers could restrict our procurement and use of tissue. (cid:0) Negative publicity concerning methods of tissue recovery and screening of donor tissue could reduce demand for our regenerative biologics products and impact the supply of available donor tissue. (cid:0) We are subject to environmental laws and regulations that can impose significant costs and expose us to potential financial liabilities. (cid:0) We or our suppliers may be the subject of claims for non-compliance with FDA regulations in connection with the processing, manufacturing or distribution of regenerative biologics implants and products. (cid:0) We and our distributor sales representatives might be subject to claims for failing to comply with U.S. federal, state, local and foreign fraud and abuse laws. Risks Related to our International Operations (cid:0) We may fail to obtain or maintain foreign regulatory approvals to market our products in other countries. (cid:0) We are subject to risks associated with our non-U.S. operations. (cid:0) Our results of operations could suffer if we are unable to manage our planned international expansion effectively. (cid:0) We are subject to risks arising from currency exchange rate fluctuations on our international transactions and translation of local currency results into U.S. dollars, which could adversely affect our profitability. Risks Related to our Financial Results and Need for Financing (cid:0) We will need to generate significant sales to remain profitable (cid:0) We may be unable to grow our revenue or earnings as anticipated, which may have a material adverse effect on our results of operations. (cid:0) Our quarterly and annual operating results may fluctuate significantly. (cid:0) We have a significant amount of outstanding indebtedness, and our financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected if we do not effectively manage our liabilities. (cid:0) The availability of funding under existing credit arrangements may be limited, and our cash and cash equivalents are subject to volatility. (cid:0) Our future capital needs are uncertain and we may need to raise funds in the future, and such funds may not be available on acceptable terms or at all. (cid:0) Our existing revolving credit facility contains restrictive covenants that may limit our operating flexibility. Risks Related to our Intellectual Property and Potential Litigation (cid:0) We could become subject to litigation that could be costly and result in the diversion of management’s time and efforts. Risks Related to the Ownership of our Class A Common Stock (cid:0) Because of their significant stock ownership, our executive officers, and our directors and principal stockholders will be able to exert control over us and our significant corporate decisions. (cid:0) We are a “controlled company” within the meaning of the New York Stock Exchange Rules. (cid:0) Our Board is authorized to issue and designate shares of our preferred stock in additional series without stockholder approval. (cid:0) Anti-takeover provisions in our organizational documents and Delaware law may discourage or prevent a change of control. 21 Table of Contents General Risk Factors (cid:0) If we do not successfully implement our business strategy, our business and results of operations will be adversely affected (cid:0) If we fail to properly manage our anticipated growth, our business could suffer. (cid:0) Fluctuations in insurance cost and availability could adversely affect our profitability or our risk management profile. (cid:0) We are exposed to the credit risk of some of our customers, which could result in material losses. (cid:0) The widespread outbreak of a communicable disease, or any other public health crisis, could adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations. Risks Relating to the Integration of NuVasive (cid:0) Integrating the NuVasive business into Globus may be more difficult, costly or time-consuming than expected and the Company may fail to realize the anticipated benefits of the Merger, which may adversely affect the Company’s business results and negatively affect the value of the Company’s common stock. (cid:0) The Company expects to incur substantial expenses related to the integration of NuVasive and may be unable to realize the anticipated synergies, which could adversely affect the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations. (cid:0) Certain contractual counterparties may seek to modify contractual relationships with the Company, which could have an adverse effect on the Company’s business and operations. (cid:0) The Company may be exposed to increased litigation, which could have an adverse effect on the Company’s business and operations. Risks Related to Our Business and Our Industry To be commercially successful, we must convince surgeons and hospitals that our products are an attractive alternative to our competitors’ products and that our Enabling Technologies and Musculoskeletal Solutions products are an attractive alternative to existing surgical treatments of musculoskeletal disorders. Surgeons play a significant role in determining the course of treatment and, ultimately, the type of product that will be used to treat a patient, so we rely on effectively marketing to them. Hospitals, however, are increasingly involved in the evaluation of products and product purchasing decisions. In order for us to sell our products, we must convince surgeons and hospitals that our products are attractive alternatives to competing products for use in procedures. Acceptance of our products depends on educating surgeons and hospitals as to the distinctive characteristics, perceived benefits, safety and cost-effectiveness of our products as compared to our competitors’ products and on training surgeons in the proper application of our products. If we are not successful in convincing surgeons and hospitals of the merit of our products or educating them on the use of our products, they may not use our products and we will be unable to increase our sales and sustain growth or profitability. Furthermore, we believe surgeons will not widely adopt certain of our most novel Musculoskeletal Solutions or Enabling Technologies products unless they determine, based on experience, clinical data and published peer-reviewed journal articles, that MIS techniques, our motion preservation, regenerative biologics, and INR technologies provide benefits or are an attractive alternative to conventional treatments of musculoskeletal disorders and incorporate improved technologies that permit novel surgical procedures. Surgeons, and in certain instances, hospitals, may be hesitant to change their medical treatment practices or the products available for use to treat patients for the following reasons, among others: (cid:0) lack of experience with MIS, motion preservation, regenerative biologics or INR technologies; (cid:0) lack or perceived lack of evidence supporting additional patient benefits; (cid:0) perceived liability risks generally associated with the use of new products and procedures; (cid:0) limited or lack of availability of coverage and reimbursement within healthcare payment systems; (cid:0) costs associated with the purchase of new products and equipment; and (cid:0) the time commitment that may be required for training. If we are unable to convince surgeons and hospitals to use our products, or long-term data does not show the benefits of using our products, we will not achieve expected sales or sustain our growth, and our financial condition and results of operation may be adversely affected. Pricing pressure from our competitors and our customers may impact our ability to sell our products at prices necessary to support our current business strategies. The musculoskeletal devices industry is characterized by intense competition and continues to attract numerous new companies and technologies, which has encouraged more established companies to intensify competitive pricing pressure. As a result of this 22 Table of Contents increased competition, as well as the challenges of third-party coverage and reimbursement practices, we believe there will be continued pricing pressure in the future. If competitive forces drive down the prices we are able to charge for our products, our profit margins will shrink, which will adversely affect our ability to maintain our profitability and to invest in and grow our business. If our hospital and other healthcare provider customers are unable to obtain adequate coverage and reimbursement for their purchases of our Musculoskeletal Solutions products, we may not be able to sell our Musculoskeletal Solutions products at prices necessary to maintain our profitability or at all. Maintaining and growing sales of our products depends on the availability of adequate coverage and reimbursement from third-party payors, including government programs such as Medicare and Medicaid, private insurance plans and managed care programs. Hospitals and other healthcare providers that purchase our Musculoskeletal Solutions products generally rely on third-party payors to cover all or part of the costs associated with the procedures performed with these products, including the cost to purchase the product. Our customers’ access to adequate coverage and reimbursement for the procedures performed with our Musculoskeletal Solutions products by government and private insurance plans is central to the acceptance of our current and future products. We may be unable to sell our Musculoskeletal Solutions products on a profitable basis, or at all, if third-party payors deny coverage or reduce their current levels of payment. If our cost of production increases faster than increases in reimbursement levels for the Musculoskeletal Solutions products, our profitability may be negatively impacted. Future action by CMS (which administers the Medicare program and provides oversight and funding to state Medicaid programs), other government agencies or private payors, may diminish payments to physicians, outpatient surgery centers and/or hospitals, which could harm our ability to market and sell our products. Private payors may adopt coverage decisions and payment amounts determined by CMS as guidelines in setting their coverage and reimbursement policies. Private payors that do not follow the Medicare guidelines may adopt different coverage and reimbursement policies for procedures performed with our products. In addition, for governmental programs, such as Medicaid, coverage and reimbursement differs from state to state. Medicaid payments to physicians and facilities are often lower than payments by other third-party payors and some state Medicaid programs may not pay an adequate amount for the procedures performed with our products, if any payment is made at all. Furthermore, the healthcare industry in the U.S. has experienced a trend toward cost containment as government and private insurers seek to control rising healthcare costs by imposing lower payment rates and negotiating reduced contract rates with service providers. Third-party payors, including public and private payors, may develop negative coverage policies impacting our Musculoskeletal Solutions products. In addition, some payors have changed their coverage policies to be more restrictive as to the criteria under which they will cover and reimburse for vertebral fusions in the lumbar spine to treat multilevel degenerative disc disease, initial primary laminectomy/discectomy for nerve root decompression, or spinal stenosis. Although these coverage policy changes have not had a material impact on our business, other insurers may adopt similar coverage decisions in the future. Patients covered by these insurers may be unwilling or unable to afford lumbar fusion surgeries to treat these conditions, which could materially harm or limit our ability to sell our Musculoskeletal Solutions products designed for lumbar fusion procedures. Our business would be negatively impacted if the trend by governmental agencies or third-party payors continues to reduce coverage of and/or reimbursement for procedures using our Musculoskeletal Solutions products. We cannot be certain that under current and future payment systems, such as those utilized by Medicare and in many private managed care systems, the cost of our Musculoskeletal Solutions products will be adequately incorporated into the overall cost of the procedure. Therefore, we cannot be certain that the procedures performed with our Musculoskeletal Solutions products will be reimbursed at a sufficiently profitable level, or at all. To the extent we sell our Musculoskeletal Solutions products internationally, market acceptance may depend, in part, upon the availability of coverage and reimbursement within prevailing healthcare payment systems. Reimbursement and healthcare payment systems in international markets vary significantly by country, and include both government-sponsored healthcare and private insurance. Our Musculoskeletal Solutions products may not obtain international coverage and reimbursement approvals in a timely manner, if at all. Our failure to receive such approvals would negatively impact market acceptance of our products in the international markets in which those approvals are sought. If we are unable to maintain and expand our network of direct sales representatives and independent distributors, we may not be able to generate anticipated sales. Our operating results are directly dependent upon the sales and marketing efforts of not only our employees, but also our independent distributors. We expect our direct sales representatives and independent distributors to develop long-lasting relationships with the surgeons they serve. If our direct sales representatives or independent distributors fail to adequately promote, market and sell our products, our sales could significantly decrease. We face significant challenges and risks in managing our geographically dispersed distribution network and retaining the individuals who make up that network. If certain of our direct sales representatives were to leave us, or if certain of our independent 23 Table of Contents distributors were to cease to do business with us, our sales could be adversely affected. Some of our independent distributors account for a significant portion of our sales volume, and if any such independent distributor were to cease to distribute our products, our sales could be adversely affected. In such a situation, we may need to seek alternative independent distributors or increase our reliance on our direct sales representatives, which may not prevent our sales from being adversely affected. If a direct sales representative or independent distributor were to depart and be retained by one of our competitors, we may be unable to prevent them from helping competitors solicit business from our existing customers, which could further adversely affect our sales. Because of the intense competition for their services, we may be unable to recruit or retain additional qualified independent distributors or to hire additional direct sales representatives to work with us. We may not be able to enter into agreements with them on favorable or commercially reasonable terms, if at all. Failure to hire or retain qualified direct sales representatives or independent distributors would prevent us from maintaining or expanding our business and generating sales. As we launch new products and increase our marketing efforts with respect to existing products, we will need to expand the reach of our marketing and sales networks. Our future success will depend largely on our ability to continue to hire, train, retain and motivate skilled direct sales representatives and independent distributors with significant technical knowledge in various areas. New hires require training and take time to achieve full productivity. If we fail to train new hires adequately, or if we experience high turnover in our sales force in the future, we cannot be certain that new hires will become as productive as may be necessary to maintain or increase our sales. If we are unable to expand our sales and marketing capabilities domestically and internationally, we may not be able to effectively commercialize our products, which would adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition. We operate in a very competitive business environment and if we are unable to compete successfully against our existing or potential competitors, our sales and operating results may be negatively affected and we may not grow. Our industry is intensely competitive, subject to rapid change and highly sensitive to the introduction of new products or other market activities of industry participants. We believe that our significant competitors are Medtronic, DePuy Synthes, Stryker, Zimmer Biomet, and Smith and Nephew. Alphatec Holdings, Orthofix, Integra LifeSciences, ZimVie and other smaller public and private companies are also competitors of ours. At any time, these or other industry participants may develop alternative treatments, products or procedures for the treatment of musculoskeletal disorders that compete directly or indirectly with our products. They may also develop and patent processes or products earlier than we can or obtain regulatory clearance or approvals for competing products more rapidly than we can, which could impair our ability to develop and commercialize similar processes or products. If alternative treatments are, or are perceived to be, superior to our musculoskeletal surgery products, sales of our products could be negatively affected and our results of operations could suffer. Many of our current and potential competitors are major medical device companies that have substantially greater financial, technical and marketing resources than we do, and they may succeed in developing products that would render our products obsolete or non-competitive. Many of our larger competitors enjoy several competitive advantages over us, including: (cid:0) greater financial, human and other resources for product research and development, sales and marketing and litigation; (cid:0) significantly greater name recognition; (cid:0) established relationships with surgeons, hospitals and other healthcare providers; (cid:0) large and established sales and marketing and distribution networks; (cid:0) products supported by long-term clinical data; (cid:0) greater experience in obtaining and maintaining regulatory clearances or approvals for products and product enhancements; (cid:0) more expansive portfolios of intellectual property rights; and (cid:0) greater ability to cross-sell their products or to incentivize hospitals or surgeons to use their products. The frequent introduction by competitors of products that compete with our existing or planned products may also make it difficult to market or sell our products. In addition, the entry of multiple new products and competitors, including PODs, may lead some of our competitors to employ pricing strategies that could adversely affect the pricing of our products and pricing in the musculoskeletal implant and device market generally. As a result, our ability to compete successfully will depend on our ability to develop proprietary products that reach the market in a timely manner, receive adequate coverage and reimbursement from third-party payors, and are safer, less invasive and more effective than alternatives available for similar purposes. If we are unable to do so, our sales or margins could decrease, thereby harming our business. 24 Table of Contents We are dependent on a limited number of third-party suppliers, and the loss of any of these suppliers, or their inability to provide us with an adequate supply of products or materials in a timely manner, could harm our business. We rely on third-party suppliers to supply many of our finished products and also various components and materials used to manufacture other products. For us to be successful, our suppliers must be able to provide us with products, components, and materials in substantial quantities, in compliance with regulatory requirements, in accordance with agreed upon specifications, at acceptable costs and on a timely basis. Our anticipated growth could strain the ability of our suppliers to deliver an increasingly large supply of products, materials and components. Other issues, including shortages of raw materials or components, problems with production yields and quality control and assurance, especially with products such as allograft, which is processed human tissue, could impair a supplier’s ability to supply us with product quantities necessary to support our sales. Furthermore, under our supplier agreements, our suppliers generally have no obligation to manufacture for us or sell to us any specific quantity of products. If we are unable to obtain sufficient quantities of high-quality components to meet demand on a timely basis, we could lose customers, our reputation may be harmed, and our business could suffer. We generally use a small number of suppliers for our products, materials and components. Our dependence on such a limited number of suppliers exposes us to risks, including limited control over pricing, availability, quality and delivery schedules. Our suppliers may be impacted by equipment failure or economic, environmental, or geopolitical factors that disrupt manufacturing capacities. If any one or more of our suppliers cease to provide us with sufficient quantities of products or materials in a timely manner or on terms acceptable to us, or cease to manufacture components of acceptable quality, we would have to seek alternative sources of supply. Because of the nature of our internal quality control requirements, regulatory requirements and the custom and proprietary nature of components, we cannot quickly engage additional or replacement suppliers for many of our critical components. Failure of any of our third-party suppliers to deliver products or materials at the level our business requires would limit our ability to meet our sales commitments to our customers and could have a material adverse effect on our business. We may also have difficulty obtaining similar components from other suppliers that are acceptable to the FDA or other foreign regulatory authorities. We could incur delays while we locate and engage qualified alternative suppliers, and we may be unable to engage alternative suppliers on favorable terms or at all. We cannot guarantee that disruptions will not occur, and any such disruption may result in decreased inventory, increased overhead costs, product shortages and decreased sales, any of which could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition, and could harm our commercialization efforts and adversely affect our ability to generate future sales. The proliferation of PODs could result in increased pricing pressure on our products or harm our ability to sell our products to physicians who own or are affiliated with those distributorships. PODs are medical device distributors that are owned, directly or indirectly, by physicians. These physicians derive a proportion of their revenue from selling or arranging for the sale of medical devices for use in procedures at hospitals that agree to purchase from or through the POD. We do not sell or distribute any of our products through PODs. The number of PODs may continue to grow as economic pressures increase throughout the industry, as hospitals, insurers and physicians search for ways to reduce costs, and, in the case of the physicians, search for ways to increase their incomes. These companies and the physicians who own, or partially own, them have significant market knowledge and access to the surgeons who use our products and the hospitals that purchase our products, and growth in this area may reduce our ability to compete effectively for business from surgeons who own such distributorships. Our business could suffer if we lose the services of key members of our senior management, key advisors or personnel. We are dependent upon the continued services of key members of our senior management and a limited number of key advisors and personnel. In particular, we are highly dependent on the skills and leadership of our Executive Chairman, David C. Paul, and our Chief Executive Officer, Daniel T. Scavilla. The loss of any one of these individuals could disrupt our operations or our strategic plans. Additionally, our future success will depend on, among other things, our ability to continue to hire and retain the necessary qualified scientific, technical and managerial personnel, for whom we compete with numerous other companies, academic institutions and organizations. The loss of members of our management team, key advisors or personnel, or our inability to attract or retain other qualified personnel or advisors, could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. Though members of our sales force generally enter into non-compete agreements that restrict their ability to compete with us, most of the members of our executive management team are not subject to such agreements. Accordingly, the adverse effect resulting from the loss of certain executives could be compounded by our inability to prevent them from competing with us. The safety and efficacy of our products is not yet supported by long-term clinical data, which could limit sales, and our products might therefore prove to be less safe and effective than initially thought. Many of our products we currently market in the U.S., have either received pre-market clearance under Section 510(k) of the Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act (“FDCA”) or are exempt from pre-market review. The FDA's 510(k) clearance process, and similar regulatory processes in other countries, requires us to show that our proposed product is “substantially equivalent” to another 25 Table of Contents 510(k)-cleared product. This process is shorter and typically requires the submission of less supporting documentation than other FDA approval processes and does not always require long-term clinical studies. Additionally, for most products launched to date, we have not been required to complete long-term clinical studies in connection with the sale of our products outside the U.S. market. Our SECURE®-C device was prospectively studied through a seven- year postoperative clinical study as part of the Postmarket Approval process. As a result, we currently lack the breadth of published long-term clinical data supporting the safety and efficacy of virtually all of our products and the benefits they offer that might have been generated in connection with other approval processes. For these reasons, surgeons may be slow to adopt our products, we may not have comparative data that our competitors have or are generating, and we may be subject to greater regulatory and product liability risks. Further, future patient studies or clinical experience may indicate that treatment with our products does not improve patient outcomes. Such results would slow the adoption of our products by surgeons, significantly reduce our ability to achieve expected sales, and could prevent us from sustaining our profitability. Moreover, if future results and experience indicate that our products cause unexpected or serious complications or other unforeseen negative effects, we could be subject to mandatory product recalls, product seizures, suspension or withdrawal of FDA clearance or approval, and significant legal liability or harm to our business reputation. If we do not enhance our existing product offerings and introduce new products through our research and development and product development efforts, we may be unable to effectively compete. In order to increase our market share, we must enhance and broaden our product offerings in response to changing customer demands and competitive pressures and technologies. The success of any new product offering or enhancement to an existing product will depend on numerous factors, including our ability to: (cid:0) properly identify and anticipate surgeon and patient needs; (cid:0) develop and introduce new products or product enhancements in a timely manner; (cid:0) adequately protect our intellectual property and avoid infringing upon the intellectual property rights of third parties; (cid:0) demonstrate the safety and efficacy of new products; and (cid:0) obtain the necessary regulatory clearances or approvals for new products or product enhancements. If we do not develop and obtain regulatory clearance or approval for new products or product enhancements in time to meet market demand, or if there is insufficient demand for these products or enhancements, our results of operations will suffer. Our research and development and product development efforts may require a substantial investment of time and resources before we are adequately able to determine the commercial viability of a new product, technology, material or other innovation. In addition, even if we are able to successfully develop enhancements or new generations of our products, these enhancements or new generations of products may not produce sales in excess of the costs of development and they may be quickly rendered obsolete by changing customer preferences or the introduction by our competitors of products embodying new technologies or features. We continue to introduce new products and services related to our the ExcelsiusGPS® platform and orthopedic trauma products. We recently launched the Excelsius3D™ imaging system. Prior to launching these platforms, we had no prior experience marketing these new products and we may launch new products in the future that we have no prior experience marketing. We will need to convince a new audience of surgeons and hospital personnel that our new products are attractive alternatives to competing products for use in applicable procedures. If we are not successful in convincing surgeons and hospitals of the merit of new products or educating them on their use, our sales and operating results may be negatively affected and we may not grow as quickly as we anticipate. We may seek to grow our business through acquisitions of or investments in new or complementary businesses, products or technologies, and the failure to manage acquisitions or investments, or the failure to integrate them with our existing business, could have a material adverse effect on us. From time to time we expect to consider opportunities to acquire or make investments in other technologies, products and businesses that may enhance our capabilities, complement our current products or expand the breadth of our markets or customer base. Potential and completed acquisitions and strategic investments involve numerous risks, including: (cid:0) problems assimilating the purchased technologies, products or business operations; (cid:0) issues maintaining uniform standards, procedures, controls and policies; (cid:0) unanticipated costs associated with acquisitions; (cid:0) diversion of management’s attention from our core business; (cid:0) adverse effects on existing business relationships with suppliers and customers; (cid:0) risks associated with entering new markets in which we have limited or no experience; (cid:0) potential loss of key employees of acquired businesses; and (cid:0) increased legal and accounting compliance costs. 26 Table of Contents We do not know if we will be able to identify acquisitions we deem suitable, whether we will be able to successfully complete any such acquisitions on favorable terms or at all, or whether we will be able to successfully integrate any acquired business, product or technology into our business or retain any key personnel, suppliers or distributors. Our ability to successfully grow through acquisitions depends upon our ability to identify, negotiate, complete and integrate suitable target businesses and to obtain any necessary financing. These efforts could be expensive and time-consuming, and may disrupt our ongoing business and prevent management from focusing on our operations. If we are unable to integrate any acquired businesses, products or technologies effectively, our business, results of operations and financial condition will be materially adversely affected. We are required to maintain high levels of inventory, which could consume a significant amount of our resources and reduce our cash flows. As a result of the need to maintain substantial levels of inventory, we are subject to the risk of inventory obsolescence. Many of our Musculoskeletal Solutions products come in sets, which feature components in a variety of sizes to satisfy the particular patient’s anatomical needs. In order to market our Musculoskeletal Solutions products effectively, we often must maintain implant sets consisting of the full range of product sizes. For each surgery, fewer than all of the components of the set are used, and therefore certain portions of the set, like uncommon sizes, may become obsolete before they can be used. In the event that a substantial portion of our inventory becomes obsolete, it could have a material adverse effect on our earnings and cash flows due to the resulting costs associated with the inventory impairment charges and costs required to replace such inventory. We rely on information technology systems and network infrastructure to operate and manage our business, if we experience a breach, cyber-attack or other disruption to these systems or data, our business, results of operations and financial condition could be adversely affected. We are increasingly dependent on sophisticated information technology systems to operate our business, including to process, transmit and store sensitive data, and many of our products and services include or use integrated software and information technology that may collect data regarding customers, patients, suppliers and third parties, or connects to our systems. Given the nature of our business, we also may maintain personally identifiable information (“PII”) or access to PHI. Specifically, we rely on our information technology systems to effectively manage sales and marketing, accounting and financial functions, inventory management, engineering and product development tasks, and our research and development data. Our business therefore depends on the continuous, effective, reliable, and secure operation of our computer hardware, software, networks, Internet servers, and related infrastructure. Although our computer and communications hardware is protected by reasonable physical, technical, and administrative safeguards, it is still vulnerable to system malfunction, computer viruses, and cybersecurity breaches – including ransomware, phishing DDoS, malware, brute force, insider threats, and other cyber attacks and security incidents. These events could lead to the unauthorized access to information systems maintained by us or our service providers or customers and result in the misappropriation or unauthorized disclosure of confidential information belonging to us, our employees, patients, partners, customers, or our suppliers. The techniques used by criminal elements to attack computer systems are sophisticated, change frequently and may originate from less regulated and remote areas of the world, including countries that engage in state-sponsored cyber attacks. As a result, we may not be able to address these techniques proactively or implement adequate preventative measures. Additionally, the regulatory environment governing information, security and privacy laws is increasingly demanding and continues to evolve. If our information technology systems are compromised, we could be subject to fines, damages, litigation and enforcement actions and we could lose trade secrets or other confidential information, the occurrence of which could harm our reputation, business, results of operations and financial condition. Our information systems, and those of third-parties with whom we contract, also require an ongoing commitment of significant resources to maintain, protect and enhance existing systems and develop new systems to keep pace with continuing changes in information technology. The failure of our information technology systems to perform as we anticipate or our failure to effectively implement new systems could disrupt our operations and could result in decreased sales, increased overhead costs, excess inventory and product shortages, all of which could have a material adverse effect on our reputation, business, results of operations and financial condition. We are subject to data privacy laws and our failure to comply with them could subject us to substantial liabilities. Our business relies on the secure electronic transmission, storage and hosting of sensitive information, including personal information, PHI, financial information, intellectual property and other sensitive information related to our customers and workforce. The collection, maintenance, protection, use, transmission, disclosure and disposal of certain personal information and the security of medical devices are regulated at the U.S. federal and state, international and industry levels. U.S. federal and state laws, such as HIPAA, protect the confidentiality of certain patient health information, including patient medical records, and restrict the use and disclosure of patient health information. In addition to the regulation of personal health information, a number of states have also adopted laws and regulations that may affect our privacy and data security practices for other kinds of PII, such as state laws that govern the use, disclosure and protection of sensitive personal information, such as social security numbers, or that are designed to protect credit card account data. 27 Table of Contents State consumer protection laws may also establish privacy and security standards for use and management of PII, including information related to customers, suppliers, and care providers. Outside the U.S., we are impacted by the privacy and data security requirements at the international, national and regional level, and on an industry specific basis. Legal requirements in the countries we serve relating to the collection, storage, handling and transfer of personal data and potentially intellectual property continue to evolve with increasingly strict enforcement regimes. More privacy and security laws and regulations are being adopted, and more are being enforced, with potential for significant financial penalties. In the EU, stringent data protection and privacy rules impact the use of patient data across the healthcare industry. The GDPR applies across the EU, with similar requirements applying to the UK and European Economic Area countries, and includes, among other things, a requirement for prompt notice of data breaches in certain circumstances and imposes significant fines for non-compliance. Data protection authorities from different EU member states may interpret and apply the GDPR somewhat differently, and the GDPR also permits EU member states to create supplemental national laws, which increases the complexity for compliance. Failure to comply with GDPR requirements could result in penalties of up to €20 million or 4% of worldwide revenue, whichever is greater, for serious violations. Within the U.S., a number of states have enacted more onerous privacy laws, such as the California Consumer Privacy Act (the “CCPA”), which also impose stricter privacy requirements and are enforced by state attorneys general and other state agencies. Any investigations or any other government actions related to the GDPR, CCPA, and other privacy laws may be costly to respond to, result in negative publicity, increase our operating costs, require significant management time and attention, and subject us to remedies that may harm our business, including fines, demands or orders that we modify or cease existing business practices. Private litigation, including class actions, related to privacy and cybersecurity issues is also on the rise in the U.S. and other countries. If we experience significant disruptions in our information technology systems, our business, results of operations and financial condition could be adversely affected. The efficient operation of our business depends on our information technology systems. We rely on our information technology systems to effectively manage: (cid:0) sales and marketing, accounting and financial functions; (cid:0) inventory management; (cid:0) engineering and product development tasks; and (cid:0) our research and development data. Our information technology systems are vulnerable to damage or interruption from: (cid:0) earthquakes, fires, floods and other natural disasters; (cid:0) terrorist attacks and attacks by computer viruses or hackers or other cybersecurity attacks or breaches; (cid:0) power losses; and (cid:0) computer systems, or Internet, telecommunications or data network failures. The failure of our information technology systems to perform as we anticipate or our failure to effectively implement new systems could disrupt our entire operation and could result in decreased sales, increased overhead costs, excess inventory and product shortages, all of which could have a material adverse effect on our reputation, business, results of operations and financial condition. Consolidation in the healthcare industry could lead to demands for price concessions or to the exclusion of some suppliers from certain of our markets, which could have an adverse effect on our business, results of operations or financial condition. Because healthcare costs have risen significantly over the past decade, numerous initiatives and reforms initiated by legislators, regulators and third-party payors to curb these costs have resulted in a consolidation trend in the healthcare industry to aggregate purchasing power. As the healthcare industry consolidates, competition to provide products and services to industry participants has become and will continue to become more intense. This in turn has resulted and will likely continue to result in greater pricing pressures and the exclusion of certain suppliers from important market segments as group purchasing organizations, independent delivery networks and large single accounts continue to use their market power to consolidate purchasing decisions for hospitals. We expect that market demand, government regulation, third-party coverage and reimbursement policies and societal pressures will continue to change the worldwide healthcare industry, resulting in further business consolidations and alliances among our customers, which may reduce competition, exert further downward pressure on the prices of our products and may adversely impact our business, results of operations or financial condition. 28 Table of Contents If our Enabling Technologies products require significant amounts of service after sale or we receive a significant number of warranty claims, our costs may increase and our financial results may be adversely affected. Sales of certain of our Enabling Technologies products that are capital equipment typically include a warranty and maintenance obligation on our part for services for a period of twelve months from the date the equipment is installed at a customer’s facility. Customers may also purchase a supplemental service plan for technical and other services for any required service beyond the initial warranty and service period. If product warranty claims or required service under the service plans exceed our expectations, we may incur additional expenditures for parts and service. In addition, our reputation could be damaged and our products may not achieve market acceptance and could result in reductions in sales. We experience long and variable capital sales cycles for our Enabling Technologies products, which may cause fluctuations in our financial results. The sales and purchase order cycle of our Enabling Technologies capital equipment products is lengthy because they are major capital items and their purchase generally requires the approval of senior management of hospitals, their parent organizations, purchasing groups, and government bodies, as applicable. In addition, sales to some of our customers are subject to competitive bidding or public tender processes. These approval and bidding processes can be lengthy. Further, the introduction of new products could adversely impact our sales cycle as customers take additional time to assess the benefits and costs of such products. As a result, it is difficult for us to predict the length of capital sales cycles and, therefore, the exact timing of capital sales. The above factors may contribute to fluctuations in our quarterly operating results. Because of these fluctuations, it is possible that in future periods our operating results will fall below the expectations of securities analysts or investors. If that happens, the market price of our stock would likely decrease. Our IONM business exposes us to risks inherent with the sale of services. Our IONM services and support business exposes us to different risks than our other products and technologies. Through NuVasive Clinical Services, a Globus subsidiary, we provide onsite and remote monitoring of the neurological systems of patients undergoing spinal and brain-related surgeries. Our neurophysiologists are present in the operating room during procedures and work with supervising physicians who remotely oversee and interpret neurophysiologic data gathered via broadband transmission over the Internet. Providing this service subjects us to malpractice exposure. In addition, given the reliance on technology, any disruption to our IONM equipment or the Internet could harm our service operations and our reputation among our customers. Further, any disruption to our information technology systems could adversely impact the performance of our neurophysiologists and oversight physicians. In addition, IONM services are directly billed to Medicare and commercial payors, which brings with it additional risks associated with proper billing practice regulations, HIPAA compliance, corporate practice of medicine laws, and collections risk associated with third-party payors. Due to the breadth of many healthcare laws and regulations, our IONM business could also be subject to healthcare fraud regulation and enforcement by both the federal government and the states in which we conduct our business, including under the Anti-Kickback Statute, the federal false claims laws and state law equivalents. Further, in December 2020, in connection with the Consolidated Appropriations Act of 2021, the No Surprises Act was signed into law in the U.S., which introduced national limitations on physician billing for certain services furnished by providers who are not in-network with the patient’s self- insured health plan, individual or group health plan. This federal law became effective on January 1, 2022, and several states where we conduct business have also enacted similar laws that would apply to patients having state-regulated insurance. These measures could limit the amount we can charge and recover for the IONM services we furnish where we have not contracted with the patient’s insurer, which could negatively impact the profitability of our IONM services business. If our operations are found to be in violation of any of these laws or any other governmental regulations that apply to us, we may be subject to sanctions, including civil penalties and damages, criminal fines and imprisonment, exclusion from participation in federal and state healthcare programs, suspension and debarment from federal procurement and non-procurement programs, refusal of orders under existing government contracts, and the curtailment or restructuring of our operations. Any penalties, damages, fines, exclusion or debarment, or curtailment or restructuring of our operations could adversely affect our ability to operate our business and our financial results. 29 Table of Contents Risks Related to our Legal and Regulatory Environment Our medical device products and operations are subject to extensive governmental regulation both in the U.S. and abroad, and our failure to comply with applicable requirements could cause our business to suffer. The medical device industry is regulated extensively by governmental authorities, principally the FDA and corresponding state and foreign regulatory agencies. The FDA and other U.S. and foreign governmental agencies regulate, among other things, with respect to medical devices: (cid:0) design, development and manufacturing; (cid:0) testing, labeling, content and language of instructions for use and storage; (cid:0) clinical trials; (cid:0) product safety; (cid:0) marketing, sales and distribution; (cid:0) pre-market clearance and approval; (cid:0) record keeping procedures; (cid:0) advertising and promotion; (cid:0) recalls and field safety corrective actions; (cid:0) post-market surveillance, including reporting of deaths or serious injuries and malfunctions that, if they were to recur, could lead to death or serious injury; (cid:0) post-market approval studies; and (cid:0) product import and export. The regulations to which we are subject are complex and have tended to become more stringent over time; see “Item 1. Business; Government Regulation” above for a summary of certain regulations to which we are subject. Regulatory changes could result in restrictions on our ability to carry on or expand our operations, higher than anticipated costs or lower than anticipated sales. The processes by which 510(k) clearance, grant of a de novo classification request, or PMA approval is obtained can be expensive and lengthy and require the payment of significant fees. The FDA’s 510(k) clearance process usually takes from three to twelve months, but may last longer. The FDA’s goal is to review de novo classification requests within 150 FDA review days, but presently, the current average review period is about eight months. The process of obtaining a PMA is much costlier and more uncertain than the 510(k) clearance process and generally takes one to three years, or even longer, from the time the application is submitted to the FDA until an approval is obtained. The process of obtaining regulatory clearances through the 510(k) process, de novo classification, or approvals through the PMA process to market a medical device in the U.S. or internationally can be costly and time- consuming, and we may not be able to obtain these clearances, grants of de novo classification, or approvals on a timely basis, if at all. In the U.S., all of our currently commercialized medical device products, other than SECURE®-C have either received premarket clearance under Section 510(k) of the FDCA or are exempt from PMA review. If the FDA requires us to go through a lengthier, more rigorous examination for future products or modifications to existing products than we had expected, our product introductions or modifications could be delayed or canceled, which could cause our sales to decline and potentially harm our ability to compete. In addition, if the FDA disagrees with our determination that a product we currently market is subject to an exemption from premarket review, the FDA may require us to submit a 510(k), de novo, or PMA and may require us to cease distribution of the product and/or recall the product unless and until we obtain 510(k) or de novo clearance or PMA. Further, even with respect to those future products where a PMA is not required, we cannot assure you that we will be able to obtain the 510(k) or de novo clearances with respect to those products. The FDA may also reclassify devices currently on the market from Class II to Class III, which could result in additional regulatory burden requiring submission and approval of a PMA prior to marketing, or could result in the FDA rescinding a 510(k) for a previously cleared device. The FDA can delay, limit or deny clearance or approval of a device for many reasons, including: (cid:0) we may not be able to demonstrate to the FDA’s satisfaction that our products are safe and effective for their intended uses; (cid:0) the data from our pre-clinical studies and clinical trials may be insufficient to support clearance or approval, where required; and (cid:0) the manufacturing process or facilities we use may not meet applicable requirements. In addition, the FDA may change its clearance and approval policies, adopt additional regulations or revise existing regulations, or take other actions which may prevent or delay approval or clearance of our products under development or impact our ability to modify our currently approved or cleared products on a timely basis. It is also possible that, if we obtain new FDA regulatory clearances 30 Table of Contents or approvals, the clearances or approvals may contain limitations on the indicated uses or may prohibit certain uses which may impact the marketability of the product. Any delay in, or failure to receive or maintain, clearance or approval for our medical device products under development could prevent us from generating revenue from these products or achieving profitability. Additionally, the FDA and other regulatory authorities have broad enforcement powers. Regulatory enforcement or inquiries, or other increased scrutiny on us, could dissuade some surgeons from using our products and adversely affect our reputation and the perceived safety and efficacy of our products. In addition, even after we have obtained the proper regulatory approval to market a product, the FDA has the power to require us to conduct post marketing studies, such as a Section 522 Order. These studies can be very expensive and time-consuming to conduct. Failure to comply with those studies in a timely manner could result in the revocation of the 510(k) clearance for the product that is subject to such a Section 522 Order and the recall or withdrawal of the product, which could prevent us from generating sales from that product in the U.S. Similarly, we must comply with numerous international laws and regulations in order to market our products outside of the U.S.; see “Item 1. Business; Government Regulation; International” above for a summary of certain international laws and regulations to which we are subject. As is the case in the U.S., the applicable regulatory body may change its clearance and approval policies, adopt additional regulations or revise existing regulations, or take other actions which may prevent or delay approval or clearance of our products under development or impact our ability to modify our currently approved or cleared products on a timely basis. Any delay in, or failure to receive or maintain, clearance or approval for our products under development could prevent us from generating revenue from these products or achieving profitability. Conducting clinical studies to obtain clinical data that might be required as part of the clinical evaluation process can be expensive and time-consuming. Additionally, the regulatory authorities have broad enforcement powers. Regulatory enforcement or inquiries, or other increased scrutiny on us, could dissuade some surgeons from using our products and adversely affect the perceived safety and efficacy of our products and our reputation. Failure to comply with applicable regulations could jeopardize our ability to sell our products and result in enforcement actions such as: (cid:0) untitled letters or warning letters; (cid:0) fines; (cid:0) injunctions; (cid:0) civil penalties; (cid:0) termination of distribution; (cid:0) recalls or seizures of products; (cid:0) delays in the introduction of products into the market; (cid:0) total or partial suspension of production; (cid:0) refusal of the FDA or other regulator to grant future clearances or approvals; (cid:0) withdrawals or suspensions of current clearances or approvals, resulting in prohibitions on sales of our products; (cid:0) refusal to grant export approvals; and/or (cid:0) in the most serious cases, criminal penalties. Any of these sanctions could result in higher than anticipated costs or lower than anticipated sales and have a material adverse effect on our reputation, business, results of operations and financial condition. Modifications to our products may require new 510(k) or de novo clearances, PMAs or PMA supplements, or may require us to cease marketing or recall the modified products until clearances or approvals are obtained. Any modification to a 510(k)-cleared device that could significantly affect its safety or effectiveness or that would constitute a major change in its intended use, requires a new 510(k) clearance or, possibly, a de novo request or approval of a PMA. The FDA requires every manufacturer to make this determination in the first instance, but the FDA may review any manufacturer’s decision. The FDA may not agree with our decisions regarding whether new clearances or approvals are necessary. We have modified some of our 510(k)-cleared products, and have determined based on our review of the applicable FDA guidance that in certain instances new 510(k) clearances or PMAs are not required. If the FDA disagrees with our determination and requires us to submit new 510(k) notifications, de novo petitions, PMAs or PMA supplements for modifications to our previously cleared products for which we have concluded that new clearances or approvals are unnecessary, we may be required to cease marketing or to recall the modified product until we obtain clearance or approval, and we may be subject to significant regulatory fines or penalties. 31 Table of Contents Our HCT/P products are subject to extensive government regulation and our failure to comply with these requirements could cause our business to suffer. In the U.S., we are marketing our human tissue products as Section 361 HCT/Ps, which are not subject to FDA premarket clearance or approval requirements. The FDA could disagree with our determination that our human tissue products are Section 361 HCT/Ps and could determine that these products are biologics requiring a biological license application approval or medical devices requiring 510(k) or de novo clearance or PMA approval, or New Drug Application approval. The FDA may then require that we cease marketing our human tissue products and/or recall the products unless and until we receive the appropriate clearance or approval from the FDA. HCT/Ps also are subject to donor eligibility and screening, CGTP, product labeling, and post market reporting requirements. If we or our suppliers fail to comply with these requirements, we could be subject to FDA enforcement action, including, for example, warning letters, fines, injunctions, product recalls or seizures, and, in the most serious cases, criminal penalties. If we or our suppliers fail to comply with the FDA’s good manufacturing practice regulations and similar international regulations, this could impair our ability to market our products in a cost-effective and timely manner. We and our third-party suppliers are required to comply with the FDA’s QSR, which covers the methods and documentation of the design, testing, production, control, quality assurance, labeling, packaging, sterilization, storage and shipping of our products. In addition, suppliers and processors of allograft must comply with the CGTP, which govern the methods used in and the facilities and controls used for the manufacture of human cell tissue and cellular and tissue-based products, record-keeping and the establishment of a quality program. The FDA audits compliance with the QSR and CGTP requirements through periodic announced and unannounced inspections of manufacturing and other facilities. The FDA may conduct inspections or audits at any time. If we or our suppliers have significant non-compliance issues or if any corrective action plan that we or our suppliers propose in response to observed deficiencies is not sufficient, the FDA could take enforcement action, including any of the following sanctions: (cid:0) untitled letters, warning letters, fines, injunctions, consent decrees and civil penalties; (cid:0) customer notifications or repair, replacement, refunds, recall, detention or seizure of our products; (cid:0) operating restrictions or partial suspension or total shutdown of production; (cid:0) refusing or delaying our requests for 510(k) or de novo clearance or PMA of new products or modified products; (cid:0) withdrawing 510(k) or de novo clearances or PMAs that have already been granted; (cid:0) refusal to grant export approval for our products; or (cid:0) criminal prosecution. Any of these sanctions could have a material adverse effect on our reputation, business, results of operations and financial condition. Outside the U.S., our products and operations are also often required to comply with standards set by industrial standards bodies, such as the ISO. Foreign regulatory bodies may evaluate our products or the testing that our products undergo against these standards. The specific standards, types of evaluation and scope of review differ among foreign regulatory bodies. We intend to comply with the standards enforced by such foreign regulatory bodies as needed to commercialize our products. If we fail to adequately comply with any of these standards, a foreign regulatory body may take adverse actions similar to those within the power of the FDA. Any such action may harm our reputation and business, and could have an adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. A recall of our products, either voluntarily or at the direction of the FDA or another governmental authority, or the discovery of serious safety issues with our products, could have a significant adverse impact on us. The FDA and similar foreign governmental authorities have the authority to require the recall of commercialized products in the event of material deficiencies or defects in design or manufacture or in the event that a product poses an unacceptable risk to health. Manufacturers may, under their own initiative, recall a product if any material deficiency in a device is found. Even if voluntary, the FDA requires that a medical device manufacturer report to the FDA any corrective action or removal of a device initiated to reduce a risk to health posed by the device. A government-mandated or voluntary recall by us or one of our distributors could occur as a result of risk to health, component failures, manufacturing errors, design or labeling defects or other deficiencies and issues. Recalls of any of our products would divert managerial and financial resources and have an adverse effect on our reputation, results of operations and financial condition, which could impair our ability to produce our products in a cost-effective and timely manner in order to meet our customers’ demands. We may also be required to bear other costs or take other actions that may have a negative impact on our future sales and our ability to generate profits. 32 Table of Contents In the EEA, we must comply with the EU Medical Device Vigilance System. Under this system, manufacturers are required to take Field Safety Corrective Actions (“FSCAs”) to reduce a risk of death or serious deterioration in the state of health associated with the use of a medical device that is already placed on the market. A FSCA may include the recall, modification, exchange, destruction or retrofitting of the device. Any adverse event involving our products, whether in the U.S. or abroad, could result in future voluntary corrective actions, such as recalls or customer notifications, or agency action, such as inspection, mandatory recall or other enforcement action. Any corrective action, whether voluntary or involuntary, as well as defending ourselves in a lawsuit, will require the dedication of our time and capital, distract management from operating our business and may harm our reputation and financial results. We may be subject to enforcement action if we engage in the off-label promotion of our products. Our promotional materials and training methods must comply with FDA and other applicable laws and regulations, including the prohibition of the promotion of off-label use. Physicians may use our products off-label, as the FDA does not restrict or regulate a physician’s choice of treatment within the practice of medicine. However, if the FDA determines that our promotional efforts constitutes promotion of an off-label use, it could request that we modify our training or promotional efforts or subject us to regulatory or enforcement actions, including the issuance of an untitled letter, a warning letter, injunction, seizure, civil penalties and criminal fines. It is also possible that other federal, state or foreign enforcement authorities, such as DOJ or HHS, might take action if they consider our promotional or training materials to constitute promotion of an unapproved/off-label use, which could result in significant criminal and/or civil sanctions under other statutory authorities, such as laws prohibiting false claims for reimbursement (e.g., the FCA). In that event, our reputation could be damaged and adoption of the products would be impaired. Although our policy is to refrain from statements that could be considered off-label promotion of our products, the FDA, or another regulatory agency or a Relator under the FCA could disagree and allege that we have engaged in off-label promotion. In addition, the off-label use of our products may increase the risk of injury to patients, and, in turn, the risk of product liability claims. Claims under the FCA initiated either by a government regulatory or enforcement authority or by a Relator and product liability claims are expensive to defend and could divert our management’s attention, result in substantial damage awards against us and harm our reputation. Governmental regulation and limited sources and suppliers could restrict our procurement and use of tissue. In the U.S., the procurement and transplantation of allograft bone tissue is subject to federal law pursuant to the NOTA, a criminal statute which prohibits the purchase and sale of human organs used in human transplantation, including bone and related tissue, for “valuable consideration.” NOTA permits reasonable payments associated with the removal, transportation, processing, preservation, quality control, implantation and storage of human bone tissue. We provide services in all of these areas in the U.S., with the exception of removal and implantation, and receive payments for all such services. We make payments to tissue banks for their services related to recovering allograft bone tissue on our behalf. If NOTA is interpreted or enforced in a manner that prevents us from receiving payment for services we render or that prevents us from paying tissue banks or certain of our clients for the services they render for us, our business could be materially adversely affected. In addition, there is similar legislation in Europe and the UK which we must abide by, including Directive 2004/23/EC in relation to human tissues and cells requiring that donation be unpaid (except for expenses and inconvenience) and voluntary. We depend on a limited number of sources of human tissue for use in some of our regenerative biologics products and a limited number of entities to process the human tissue for use in those regenerative biologics products, and any failure to obtain tissue from these sources or to have the tissue processed by these entities for us in a timely manner will interfere with our ability to effectively meet demand for our regenerative biologics products incorporating human tissue. Less than five third-party suppliers currently supply all of our needs for allograft implants and products, other than those implants and products that we process ourselves. The processing of human tissue into our regenerative biologics products is very labor-intensive and it is therefore difficult to maintain a steady supply stream. In addition, due to seasonal changes in mortality rates, some scarce tissues used in our regenerative biologics products are at times in particularly short supply. We cannot be certain that our current supply of human tissue and allograft implants, plus any additional source that we identify in the future, will be sufficient to meet our needs. Our dependence on a small number of third-party suppliers and the challenges we may face in obtaining adequate supplies of human tissue involve several risks, including limited control over pricing, availability, quality and delivery schedules. In addition, any interruption in the supply of any human tissue component could materially harm our and our third-party suppliers’ ability to manufacture our regenerative biologics products until a new source of supply, if any, could be found. We may be unable to find a sufficient alternative supply channel in a reasonable time period or on commercially reasonable terms, if at all, which would have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. 33 Table of Contents Negative publicity concerning methods of tissue recovery and screening of donor tissue in our industry could reduce demand for our regenerative biologics products and impact the supply of available donor tissue. Media reports or other negative publicity concerning both alleged improper methods of tissue recovery from donors and disease transmission from donated tissue could limit widespread acceptance of some of our regenerative biologics products. Unfavorable reports of improper or illegal tissue recovery practices, both in the U.S.and internationally, as well as incidents of improperly processed tissue leading to the transmission of disease, may broadly affect the rate of future tissue donation and market acceptance of technologies incorporating human tissue. In addition, such negative publicity could cause the families of potential donors to become reluctant to agree to donate tissue to for-profit tissue processors. For example, the media has reported examples of alleged illegal harvesting of body parts from cadavers and resulting recalls conducted by certain companies selling human tissue-based products affected by the alleged illegal harvesting. These reports and others could have a negative effect on our tissue regeneration business. We are subject to environmental laws and regulations that can impose significant costs and expose us to potential financial liabilities. The manufacture of certain of our products, including our allograft implants and products, and the handling of materials used in the product testing process, including in our cadaveric laboratory, involve the controlled use of biological, hazardous and/or radioactive materials and wastes. Our business and facilities and those of our suppliers are subject to foreign, federal, state and local laws and regulations relating to the protection of human health and the environment, including those governing the use, manufacture, storage, handling and disposal of, and exposure to, such materials and wastes. In addition, under some environmental laws and regulations, we could be held responsible for costs relating to any contamination at our past or present facilities and at third-party waste disposal sites even if such contamination was not caused by us. A failure to comply with current or future environmental laws and regulations could result in severe fines or penalties. Any such expenses or liability could have a significant negative impact on our business, results of operations and financial condition. We or our suppliers may be the subject of claims for non-compliance with FDA regulations in connection with the processing, manufacturing or distribution of our proposed allograft or other regenerative biologics implants and products. Allegations may be made against us or against donor recovery groups or tissue banks, including those with which we have a contractual supplier relationship, claiming that the acquisition or processing of tissue for allograft implants and products or other regenerative biologics products does not comply with applicable FDA regulations or other relevant statutes and regulations. Allegations like these could cause regulators or other authorities to take investigative or other action against us or our suppliers, or could cause negative publicity for us or our industry generally. These actions or any negative publicity could cause us to incur substantial costs, divert the attention of our management from our business and harm our reputation. We and our distributor sales representatives might be subject to claims for failing to comply with U.S. federal, state, local and foreign fraud and abuse laws, including anti-kickback laws and other anti-referral laws. There are numerous U.S. federal and state laws pertaining to healthcare fraud and abuse, including anti-kickback laws. False claims laws and physician self-referral laws. Our relationships with surgeons, hospitals and our independent distributors are subject to scrutiny under these laws. Violations of these laws are punishable by criminal and civil sanctions, including, in some instances, imprisonment and exclusion from participation in federal and state healthcare programs, including the Medicare, Medicaid and Veterans Administration health programs. Because of the broad and far-reaching nature of these laws, we may be required to alter or discontinue one or more of our business practices. Healthcare fraud and abuse regulations are complex, and even minor irregularities can potentially give rise to claims that a statute or prohibition has been violated. Examples of laws that may affect our ability to operate include: (cid:0) the Federal Anti-Kickback Statute, which prohibits, among other things, persons from knowingly and willfully soliciting, receiving, offering or paying remuneration, directly or indirectly, in exchange for, to induce or to reward either the referral of an individual for, or the purchase, order or recommendation of, any good or service for which payment may be made under federal healthcare programs such as the Medicare and Medicaid programs; (cid:0) federal false claims laws which prohibit, among other things, individuals or entities from knowingly presenting, or causing to be presented, claims for payment to Medicare, Medicaid, or other government payors that are false or fraudulent; (cid:0) HIPAA, which created federal criminal laws that prohibit executing a scheme to defraud any healthcare benefit program or making false statements relating to healthcare matters; (cid:0) the Federal Trade Commission Act and similar laws regulating advertisement and consumer protections; (cid:0) the FCPA, which prohibits corrupt payments, gifts or transfers of value to foreign officials; (cid:0) the Physician Payment Sunshine Act, which requires medical device companies to report ownership and investment interests by physicians and members of their immediate family as well as certain payments and other transfers of value, including gifts 34 Table of Contents and other benefits, provided to physicians and certain other healthcare professionals licensed in the U.S. and to teaching hospitals; and (cid:0) foreign and U.S. state law and code equivalents of each of the above federal laws, such as anti-kickback and false claims laws and disclosure of transfers of value and gift bans with respect to healthcare professionals, some of which may apply to items or services reimbursed by any third- party payor, including commercial insurers. Possible sanctions for violation of these laws include monetary penalties and other civil and criminal sanctions, exclusion from Medicare and Medicaid programs and forfeiture of amounts collected in violation of such prohibitions. Any violations of these laws, or any action against us for violation of these laws, even if we successfully defend against it, could result in a material adverse effect on our reputation, business, results of operations and financial condition. We have entered into consulting, royalty and other agreements with surgeons, including some who make referrals to us. In addition, some of our referring surgeons own our stock, which they either purchased in an arm’s length transaction on terms identical to those offered to non-referral sources or received from us as fair market value consideration for consulting services performed. While these transactions were structured with the intention of complying with all applicable laws, including the federal ban on physician self-referrals, commonly known as the “Stark Law,” state anti-referral laws and other applicable anti-kickback laws, it is possible that regulatory agencies may view these transactions as prohibited arrangements that must be restructured, or discontinued, or for which we could be subject to other significant penalties. Regulators also could prohibit us from accepting payment for products ordered or recommended by these surgeons. We would be materially and adversely affected if regulatory agencies interpret our financial relationships with surgeons who order our products to be in violation of applicable laws and we were unable to comply with applicable laws. This could subject us to monetary penalties for non-compliance, the cost of which could be substantial. To enforce compliance with the federal laws, the DOJ has increased its scrutiny of interactions between healthcare companies and healthcare providers, which has led to a number of investigations, prosecutions, convictions and settlements in the healthcare industry. Dealing with investigations can be time- and resource-consuming and can divert management’s attention from the business. Additionally, if an investigation were initiated involving us and we decided to settle that investigation with the DOJ or other law enforcement agencies, we may be forced to agree to additional onerous and expensive compliance and reporting requirements for a period of years as part of a consent decree, requirement for a corporate monitor or corporate integrity agreement. Any such investigation or settlement could increase our costs or otherwise have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. In addition, there has been a recent trend of increased federal and state regulation on payments and other transfers of value made to healthcare professionals related to marketing and other activities. Some states mandate implementation of healthcare compliance programs, impose gift bans, and/or require the tracking and reporting of gifts, compensation and other remuneration to physicians and certain other U.S. licensed healthcare professionals and U.S. teaching hospitals. The shifting commercial compliance environment and the need to build and maintain robust and expandable systems to comply with different compliance and/or reporting requirements in multiple jurisdictions increase the possibility that a healthcare company may run afoul of one or more of the requirements. The scope and enforcement of these laws is uncertain and subject to rapid change in the current environment of healthcare reform, especially in light of the lack of applicable precedent and regulations. Federal or state regulatory and enforcement authorities might challenge our current or future activities under these laws. Plaintiffs’ attorneys acting on behalf of FCA Relators, who are incentivized to pursue claims against manufacturers by the potential to share in any monetary damages and penalties recovered by the government, also might initiate lawsuits that challenge our current or future activities under these laws. Any such challenges by regulatory authorities directly or by Relators suing on behalf of the government could have a material adverse effect on our reputation, business, results of operations and financial condition. In addition to the sanctions described above, any state or federal regulatory review or FCA lawsuit, regardless of the outcome, would be costly and time-consuming and could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations. 35 Table of Contents Risks Related to our International Operations We may fail to obtain or maintain foreign regulatory approvals to market our products in other countries. We currently market our products internationally and intend to expand our international marketing. International jurisdictions require separate regulatory approvals and compliance with numerous and varying regulatory requirements. For example, we intend to continue to seek regulatory clearance to market our primary products in the EEA, Japan, Brazil, Canada and other key markets. The approval procedures vary among countries and may involve requirements for additional testing, and the time required to obtain approval may differ from country to country and from that required to obtain FDA clearance or approval. Clearance or approval by the FDA does not ensure approval or certification by regulatory authorities in other countries or jurisdictions, and approval or certification by one foreign regulatory authority does not ensure approval or certification by regulatory authorities in other foreign countries or by the FDA. The foreign regulatory approval or certification process may include all of the risks associated with obtaining FDA clearance or approval. We may not obtain foreign regulatory approvals on a timely basis, if at all. We may not be able to file for regulatory approvals or certifications and may not receive necessary approvals to commercialize our products in any market. If we fail to receive necessary approvals or certifications to commercialize our products in foreign jurisdictions on a timely basis, or at all, our business, results of operations and financial condition could be adversely affected. Additionally, in the EEA, we must inform the Notified Body that carried out the conformity assessment of the medical devices we market or sell in the EEA of any planned substantial changes to our quality system or changes to our devices which could affect compliance with the essential requirements or the devices’ intended use. The Notified Body will then assess the changes and verify whether they affect the products’ conformity. If the assessment is not favorable, it could prevent us from selling that product in the EEA, which could adversely impact our business and results of operations. In addition, on January 1, 2021 the UK left the EU. EU CE markings for medical devices will continue to be recognized in Great Britain until June 30, 2028, and certificates issued for medical devices by EU-recognized Notified Bodies will continue to be valid for the Great Britain market until June 30, 2028 and the EU no longer recognizes UK Notified Bodies. The UK has given no commitment to follow the new EU medical devices legislation (Regulation EU 2017/745) and has recently consulted on the form and content of new UK legislation which may result in divergence from the EU regime. We are subject to risks associated with our non-U.S. operations. The FCPA and similar worldwide anti-bribery laws in non-U.S. jurisdictions generally prohibit companies and their intermediaries from making improper payments for the purpose of obtaining or retaining business. The FCPA also imposes accounting standards and requirements on publicly traded U.S. corporations and their foreign affiliates, which are intended to prevent the diversion of corporate funds to the payment of bribes and other improper payments, and to prevent the establishment of “off books” slush funds from which such improper payments can be made. Because of the predominance of government-sponsored healthcare systems around the world, many of our customer relationships outside of the U.S. are with governmental entities and are therefore subject to such anti-bribery laws. Our internal control policies and procedures may not always protect us from reckless or criminal acts committed by our employees or agents. Violations of these laws, or allegations of such violations, could disrupt our operations, involve significant management distraction and result in a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. We also could suffer severe penalties, including criminal and civil penalties, disgorgement and other remedial measures, including further changes or enhancements to our procedures, policies and controls, as well as potential personnel changes and disciplinary actions. Furthermore, we are subject to the export controls and economic embargo rules and regulations of the U.S., including, but not limited to, the Export Administration Regulations and trade sanctions against embargoed countries, which are administered by the Office of Foreign Assets Control within the Department of the Treasury, as well as the laws and regulations administered by the Department of Commerce. These regulations limit our ability to market, sell, distribute or otherwise transfer our products or technology to prohibited countries or persons. A determination that we have failed to comply, whether knowingly or inadvertently, may result in substantial penalties, including fines and enforcement actions and civil and/or criminal sanctions, the disgorgement of profits and the imposition of a court-appointed monitor, as well as the denial of export privileges, and may have an adverse effect on our reputation. These and other factors may have a material adverse effect on our international operations or on our business, results of operations and financial condition generally. Our results of operations could suffer if we are unable to manage our planned international expansion effectively. Expansion into international markets is an element of our business strategy and involves risk. The sale and shipment of our products across international borders, as well as the purchase of components and products from international sources, subject us to extensive U.S. and foreign governmental trade, import and export and customs regulations and laws. Compliance with these regulations 36 Table of Contents and laws is costly and exposes us to penalties for non-compliance. Other laws and regulations that can significantly affect us include various anti-bribery laws, including the FCPA and anti-boycott laws. Any failure to comply with applicable legal and regulatory obligations in the U.S. or abroad could adversely affect us in a variety of ways that include, but are not limited to, significant criminal, civil and administrative penalties, including imprisonment of individuals, fines and penalties, denial of export privileges, seizure of shipments and restrictions on certain business activities. Also, the failure to comply with applicable legal and regulatory obligations could result in the disruption of our distribution and sales activities. Our international operations expose us and our independent distributors to risks inherent in operating in foreign jurisdictions, including: (cid:0) exposure to different legal and regulatory standards; (cid:0) lack of stringent protection of intellectual property; (cid:0) obstacles to obtaining domestic and foreign export, import and other governmental approvals, permits and licenses and compliance with foreign laws; (cid:0) potentially adverse tax consequences and the complexities of foreign value-added tax systems; (cid:0) adverse changes in tariffs and trade restrictions; (cid:0) foreign exchange rate risk; (cid:0) limitations on the repatriation of earnings; (cid:0) difficulties in staffing and managing foreign operations; (cid:0) transportation delays and difficulties of managing international distribution channels; (cid:0) longer collection periods and difficulties in collecting receivables from foreign entities; (cid:0) increased financing costs; and (cid:0) political, social and economic instability and increased security concerns. These risks may limit or disrupt our expansion, restrict the movement of funds or result in the deprivation of contractual rights or the taking of property by nationalization or expropriation without fair compensation. Our goal of succeeding as an international company depends, in part, on our ability to develop and implement policies and strategies that are effective in anticipating and managing these and other risks in the countries in which we do business. Failure to manage these and other risks may have a material adverse effect on our operations in any particular country and on our business as a whole. We are subject to risks arising from currency exchange rate fluctuations on our international transactions and translation of local currency results into U.S. dollars, which could adversely affect our profitability. International operations account for approximately 18.4% of our total net sales, and we intend to continue to expand our international presence. A significant portion of our foreign revenues and expenses are generated in Japan, the Euro zone, UK and Australia. As our reporting currency is the U.S. dollar, significant changes in currency exchange rates can result in increased exposure to foreign exchange effects on our consolidated results of operations. We cannot predict changes in currency exchange rates, the impact of exchange rate changes, nor the degree to which we will be able to manage the impact of currency exchange rate changes. Risks Related to our Financial Results and Need for Financing We will need to generate significant sales to remain profitable. We intend to increase our operating expenses substantially as we add sales representatives and distributors to increase our geographic sales coverage, submit additional investigational device exemption applications to the FDA, increase our marketing capabilities, conduct clinical trials and increase our general and administrative functions to support our growing operations. We will need to generate significant sales to maintain profitability and we might not be able to do so. Even if we do generate significant sales, we might not be able to sustain or increase profitability on a quarterly or annual basis in the future. If our sales grow more slowly than we anticipate or if our operating expenses exceed our expectations, our business, financial condition and results of operations will likely be adversely affected. We may be unable to grow our revenue or earnings as anticipated, which may have a material adverse effect on our results of operations. We have experienced rapid growth since our inception and increased our net sales to $1,568.5 million in 2023. Our ability to achieve future growth will depend upon, among other things, the success of our growth strategies, which we cannot assure will be successful. In addition, we may have more difficulty maintaining our historical or prior rate of growth of revenues, profitability or cash 37 Table of Contents flows. Our future success will depend upon numerous factors, including the strength of our brand, the market success of our current and future products, competitive conditions, our ability to attract and retain our employees and our ability to manage our business and implement our growth strategy. If we are unable to achieve future growth, our business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected. In addition, we anticipate significantly expanding our infrastructure and adding personnel in connection with our anticipated growth, which we expect will cause our selling, general and administrative expenses to increase, which could adversely impact our results of operations. Our quarterly and annual operating results may fluctuate significantly. Our operating results are difficult to predict and may be subject to periodic fluctuations. Our sales and results of operations will be affected by numerous factors, including: (cid:0) our ability to drive increased sales of our products; (cid:0) our ability to establish and maintain an effective and dedicated sales force; (cid:0) pricing pressure applicable to our products, including adverse third-party coverage and reimbursement outcomes; (cid:0) results of clinical research and trials on our existing products and products in development; (cid:0) the mix of our products sold because profit margins differ amongst our products; (cid:0) timing of new product offerings, acquisitions, licenses or other significant events by us or our competitors; (cid:0) the ability of our suppliers to timely provide us with an adequate supply of materials and components; (cid:0) the evolving product offerings of our competitors; (cid:0) regulatory approvals and legislative changes affecting the products we may offer or those of our competitors; (cid:0) interruption in the manufacturing or distribution of our products; (cid:0) the effect of competing technological, industry and market developments; (cid:0) changes in our ability to obtain regulatory clearance or approval for our products; and (cid:0) our ability to expand the geographic reach of our sales and marketing efforts. Many of the products we may seek to develop and introduce in the future will require FDA approval or clearance before commercialization in the U.S., and commercialization of such products outside of the U.S. would likely require additional regulatory approvals and import licenses. As a result, it will be difficult for us to forecast demand for these products with any degree of certainty. In addition, we will be increasing our operating expenses as we expand our commercial capabilities. Accordingly, we may experience significant, unanticipated quarterly or annual losses. If our quarterly or annual operating results fall below the expectations of investors or securities analysts, the price of our Class A common stock could decline substantially. Furthermore, any quarterly or annual fluctuations in our operating results may, in turn, cause the price of our Class A common stock to fluctuate substantially. We believe that quarterly comparisons of our financial results are not necessarily meaningful and should not be relied upon as an indication of our future performance. Negative trends in the general economy, including interest rate fluctuations, increases in inflation, and financial market volatility may adversely affect our business and financial performance. If inflation in the cost of raw materials increases beyond our ability to manage it, we may not be able to adjust prices sufficiently to offset the effect of the various cost increases without negatively impacting our consumer demand. We have a significant amount of outstanding indebtedness, and our financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected if we do not effectively manage our liabilities. As of December 31, 2023, we had outstanding $450.0 million aggregate principal amount of our 0.375% Convertible Senior Notes due March 15, 2025, (the “2025 Notes”). This significant amount of debt has important risks to us and our investors, including: (cid:0) requiring a portion of our cash flow from operations to make interest payments on this debt; (cid:0) increasing our vulnerability to general adverse economic and industry conditions; (cid:0) reducing the cash flow available to fund capital expenditures and other corporate purposes and to grow our business; (cid:0) limiting our flexibility in planning for, or reacting to, changes in our business and the industry; and (cid:0) limiting our ability to borrow additional funds as needed or take advantage of business opportunities as they arise. The availability of funding under existing credit arrangements may be limited, and our cash and cash equivalents are subject to volatility. Any lender that is obligated to provide funding to us under any now existing or future credit agreement with us may not be able to provide funding in a timely manner, or at all, when we require it. The cost of, or lack of, available credit or equity financing could 38 Table of Contents impact our ability to develop sufficient liquidity to maintain or grow our company, which in turn may adversely affect our business, results of operations or financial condition. We also manage cash and cash equivalents and short-term investments through various institutions. There may be a risk of loss on investments based on the volatility of the underlying instruments that will prevent us from recovering the full principal of our investments. Negative changes in domestic and global economic conditions or disruptions of either or both of the financial and credit markets may also affect third-party payors and may have a material adverse effect on our stock price, business, results of operations, financial condition and liquidity. Our future capital needs are uncertain and we may need to raise funds in the future, and such funds may not be available on acceptable terms or at all. Continued expansion of our business will be expensive and we may seek funds from public and private stock offerings, borrowings under our existing or future credit facilities or other sources. Our capital requirements will depend on many factors, including: (cid:0) the revenues generated by sales of our products; (cid:0) the costs associated with expanding our sales and marketing efforts; (cid:0) the expenses we incur in manufacturing and selling our products; (cid:0) the costs of developing and commercializing new products or technologies; (cid:0) the cost of obtaining and maintaining regulatory approval or clearance of our products and products in development; (cid:0) the number and timing of acquisitions and other strategic transactions; (cid:0) the costs associated with our planned international expansion; (cid:0) the costs associated with increased capital expenditures, including fixed asset purchases of instrument sets which we loan to hospitals to support surgeries; and (cid:0) unanticipated general and administrative expenses. As a result of these factors, we may seek to raise capital, and such capital may not be available on favorable terms, or at all. Furthermore, if we issue equity or debt securities to raise capital, our existing stockholders may experience dilution, and the new equity or debt securities may have rights, preferences and privileges senior to those of our existing stockholders. In addition, if we raise capital through collaboration, licensing or other similar arrangements, it may be necessary to relinquish valuable rights to our products, potential products or proprietary technologies, or grant licenses on terms that are not favorable to us. If we cannot raise capital on acceptable terms, we may not be able to develop or enhance our products, execute our business plan, take advantage of future opportunities, or respond to competitive pressures, changes in our supplier relationships, or unanticipated customer requirements. Any of these events could adversely affect our ability to achieve our development and commercialization goals, which could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. Our existing revolving credit facility contains restrictive covenants that may limit our operating flexibility. Our existing revolving credit facility contains certain restrictive covenants that could limit our ability to transfer or dispose of assets, merge with other companies or consummate certain changes of control, acquire other companies, pay dividends, incur additional indebtedness and liens, experience changes in management and enter into new businesses. We therefore may not be able to engage in any of the foregoing transactions unless we obtain the consent of the lender or terminate the revolving credit facility. There is no guarantee that we will be able to generate sufficient cash flow or sales to meet the financial covenants or pay the principal and interest on any such debt. Furthermore, there is no guarantee that future working capital, borrowings or equity financing will be available to repay or refinance any such debt. Risks Related to our Intellectual Property and Potential Litigation Our ability to protect our intellectual property and proprietary technology is uncertain. We rely primarily on patent, copyright, trademark and trade secret laws, as well as confidentiality and non-disclosure agreements and other methods, to protect our proprietary technologies and know-how. We have applied for patent protection relating to certain existing and proposed products and processes. While we generally apply for patents in those countries where we intend to make, have made, use or sell patented products, we may not accurately predict all of the countries where patent protection will ultimately be desirable. If we fail to timely file a patent application in any such country, we may be precluded from doing so at a later date. Furthermore, we cannot assure you that any of our patent applications will be approved. The rights granted to us under our patents, including prospective rights sought in our pending patent applications, may not be meaningful or provide us with any commercial advantage and they could be opposed, contested or circumvented by our competitors or be declared invalid or unenforceable in judicial or administrative proceedings. The failure of our patents to adequately protect our technology might make it easier for our competitors to offer the same or similar products or technologies. Competitors may be able to design around our patents or develop products that provide outcomes which are comparable to ours without infringing on our intellectual property rights. We have entered into 39 Table of Contents confidentiality agreements and intellectual property assignment agreements with our officers, employees, consultants and advisors regarding our intellectual property and proprietary technology. In the event of unauthorized use or disclosure or other breaches of such agreements, we may not be provided with meaningful protection for our trade secrets or other proprietary information. Due to differences between foreign and U.S. patent laws, our patented intellectual property rights may not receive the same degree of protection in foreign countries as they would in the U.S. Even if patents are granted outside the U.S., effective enforcement in those countries may not be available. Since most of our issued patents and pending patent applications are for the U.S. only, we lack a corresponding scope of patent protection in other countries. In countries where we do not have significant patent protection, we may not be able to stop a competitor from marketing products in such countries that are the same as or similar to our products. We rely on our trademarks, trade names and brand names to distinguish our products from the products of our competitors, and have registered or applied to register many of these trademarks. We cannot assure you that our trademark applications will be approved. Third parties may also oppose our trademark applications, or otherwise challenge our use of the trademarks. In the event that our trademarks are successfully challenged, we could be forced to rebrand our products, which could result in loss of brand recognition, and could require us to devote resources to advertising and marketing new brands. Further, we cannot assure you that competitors will not infringe upon our trademarks, or that we will have adequate resources to enforce our trademarks. If a competitor infringes upon one of our patents, trademarks or other intellectual property rights, enforcing those patents, trademarks and other rights may be difficult and time consuming. Even if successful, litigation to defend our patents and trademarks against challenges or to enforce our intellectual property rights could be expensive and time consuming and could divert management’s attention from managing our business. Moreover, we may not have sufficient resources or desire to defend our patents or trademarks against challenges or to enforce our intellectual property rights. The medical device industry is characterized by patent litigation and we could become subject to litigation that could be costly, result in the diversion of management’s time and efforts, require us to pay damages, and/or prevent us from marketing our existing or future products. Our commercial success will depend in part on not infringing the patents or violating the other proprietary rights of third parties. Significant litigation regarding patent rights exists in our industry. Our competitors in both the U.S. and abroad, many of which have substantially greater resources and have made substantial investments in competing technologies, may have applied for or obtained or may in the future apply for and obtain, patents that will prevent, limit or otherwise interfere with our ability to make and sell our products. We have not conducted an independent review of patents issued to third parties. The large number of patents, the rapid rate of new patent issuances, the complexities of the technology involved and uncertainty of litigation increase the risk of business assets and management’s attention being diverted to patent litigation. We have received in the past, and expect to receive in the future, communications from various industry participants alleging our infringement of their patents, trade secrets or other intellectual property rights and/or offering licenses to such intellectual property. We are currently subject to lawsuits, and have received other written allegations, claiming that we have infringed certain patents of others in the spine industry. A summary of these cases is provided under “Item 3. Legal Proceedings” below. Any lawsuits resulting from such allegations could subject us to significant liability for damages, and invalidate our proprietary rights. Any potential intellectual property litigation also could force us to do one or more of the following: (cid:0) stop selling products or using technology that contains the allegedly infringing intellectual property; (cid:0) lose the opportunity to license our technology to others or to collect royalty payments based upon successful protection and assertion of our intellectual property rights against others; (cid:0) incur significant legal expenses; (cid:0) pay substantial damages to the party whose intellectual property rights we may be found to be infringing; (cid:0) redesign those products that contain the allegedly infringing intellectual property, which could be costly and disruptive; or (cid:0) attempt to obtain a license to the relevant intellectual property from third parties, which may not be available on reasonable terms or at all. Any litigation or claim against us, even those without merit, may cause us to incur substantial costs, and could place a significant strain on our financial resources, divert the attention of management from our core business, and harm our reputation. Further, as the number of participants in the musculoskeletal industry grows, the possibility of intellectual property infringement claims against us increases. If we are found to infringe the intellectual property rights of third parties, we could be required to pay substantial damages (including treble, or triple, damages if an infringement is found to be willful) and/or royalties and could be prevented from selling our products unless we obtain a license or are able to redesign our products to avoid infringement. Any such license may not be available on reasonable terms, if at all, and there can be no assurance that we would be able to redesign our products in a way that would not infringe the intellectual property rights of others. If we fail to obtain any required licenses or make any necessary changes to our products or technologies, we may have to withdraw existing products from the market or may be unable to commercialize one or more of our products, all of which could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. 40 Table of Contents Further, in the course of our regular review of pending legal matters, we determine whether it is probable that a potential loss relating to a legal proceeding may have a material impact on our business, financial performance or cash position. However, estimates of probable losses are inherently uncertain, and even if we determine that a loss is probable, in accordance with authoritative accounting guidance, if we are unable to estimate the possible loss or range of loss, we do not record an accrual related to such litigation. As a result of this accounting policy, we may experience variability in our results of operations if damages for which we are found liable exceed the amounts we have accrued. In addition, we generally indemnify our customers and distributors with respect to infringement by our products of the proprietary rights of third parties. Third parties may assert infringement claims against our customers or distributors. These claims may require us to initiate or defend protracted and costly litigation on behalf of our customers or distributors, regardless of the merits of these claims. If any of these claims succeed, we may be forced to pay damages on behalf of our customers or distributors or may be required to obtain licenses for the products they use. If we cannot obtain all necessary licenses on commercially reasonable terms, our customers may be forced to stop using our products. We may be subject to damages resulting from claims that we, our employees or our independent distributors have wrongfully used or disclosed alleged trade secrets, proprietary or confidential information of our competitors or are in breach of non-competition or non-solicitation agreements with our competitors. Many of our employees were previously employed at other medical device companies, including our competitors or potential competitors, in some cases until recently. Many of our independent distributors sell, or in the past have sold, products of our competitors. We may be subject to claims that we, our employees, or our independent distributors have inadvertently or otherwise used or disclosed trade secrets or other proprietary information of these former employers or competitors. In addition, we have been and may in the future be subject to claims that we caused an employee to breach the terms of his or her non-competition or non-solicitation agreement. Litigation may be necessary to defend against these claims. Even if we are successful in defending against these claims, litigation could result in substantial costs and could be a distraction to management. If our defense to those claims fails, in addition to paying monetary damages, we may lose valuable personnel. There can be no assurance that this type of litigation will not continue, and any future litigation or the threat thereof may adversely affect our ability to hire additional direct sales representatives. A loss of key personnel or their work product could hamper or prevent our ability to commercialize product candidates, which could have an adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition. We may incur product liability losses and insurance coverage may be inadequate or unavailable to cover these losses. Our business exposes us to potential product liability claims that are inherent in the testing, design, manufacture and sale of medical devices for surgical procedures. The development of allograft implants and technologies for human tissue repair and treatment may entail particular risk of transmitting diseases to human recipients, which could result in the assertion of substantial product liability claims against us. Surgery involves significant risk of serious complications, including bleeding, nerve injury, paralysis and even death. In addition, if longer-term patient results and experience indicates that our products or any component of a product cause tissue damage, motor impairment or other adverse effects, we could be subject to significant liability. Furthermore, if surgeons are not sufficiently trained in the use of our products, they may misuse or ineffectively use our products, which may result in unsatisfactory patient outcomes or patient injury. We could become the subject of product liability lawsuits alleging that component failures, manufacturing flaws, design defects or inadequate disclosure of product-related risks or product-related information resulted in an unsafe condition or injury to patients. The medical devices industry has been particularly prone to potential product liability claims that are inherent in the testing, manufacture and sale of medical devices and products for surgery procedures. A product liability or other damages claim, product recall or product misuse, regardless of the outcome, could require us to spend significant time and money in litigation or to pay significant damages or costs, and could seriously harm our business. If our product liability insurance is inadequate to pay a damages award, we may have to pay the excess out of our cash reserves, which may harm our financial condition. Any product liability claim brought against us, with or without merit, could result in the increase of the costs we incur to obtain product liability insurance or our inability to secure product liability coverage in the future. If any of our products are found to cause tissue damage, motor impairment or other adverse effects, we could be subject to significant liability. Even a meritless or unsuccessful product liability claim could harm our reputation in the industry, impair our ability to sell one or more of our products in the future, result in significant legal fees and cause significant diversion of management’s attention from managing our business. A product liability or other claim, product recall, or product misuse involving any of our products, whether or not meritorious, could also materially and adversely harm our reputation and our ability to attract and retain customers. In addition, any product liability claim brought against us, with or without merit, could result in an increase of our product liability insurance rates. Insurance coverage varies in cost and can be difficult to obtain, and we cannot guarantee that we will be able to obtain insurance coverage in the future on terms acceptable to us or at all. 41 Table of Contents Risks Related to the Ownership of our Class A Common Stock Because of their significant stock ownership, our Executive Chairman, our chief executive officer, our other executive officers, and our directors and principal stockholders will be able to exert control over us and our significant corporate decisions. Because of their significant stock ownership, our Executive Chairman, our chief executive officer, our other executive officers, and our directors will be able to exert substantial control over us and our significant corporate decisions. Based on an aggregate of 136,335,662 shares of our Class A and Class B common stock outstanding as of December 31, 2023, our executive officers and directors and their affiliates beneficially owned, in the aggregate, approximately 66.1% of the voting power of our outstanding capital stock. In particular, as of December 31, 2023, David C. Paul, our Executive Chairman, and his family members, controlled approximately 16.3% of our Class A and Class B common stock, representing approximately 65.8% of the voting power of our outstanding capital stock as of that date. As a result, David C. Paul has, and these persons acting together have, the ability to significantly influence or determine the outcome of all matters submitted to our stockholders for approval, including the election and removal of directors and any merger, consolidation, or sale of all or substantially all of our assets. Furthermore, as of December 31, 2023, we had 192,602,552 shares of Class B common stock available for issuance. This amount exceeds 5% of our outstanding common stock, meaning our Board of Directors (“Board”) could issue Class B common stock without necessarily triggering the automatic conversion of that Class B common stock to Class A common stock that, pursuant to our charter, will occur when any holder’s shares of Class B common stock represents less than 5% of the aggregate number of all outstanding shares of our common stock, thereby further concentrating the voting power of our capital stock in a limited number of stockholders. The interests of our executive officers, directors and principal stockholders might not coincide with the interests of the other holders of our capital stock. This concentration of ownership may harm the value of our Class A common stock by, among other things: (cid:0) delaying, deferring or preventing a change in control of our company; (cid:0) impeding a merger, consolidation, takeover or other business combination involving our company; or (cid:0) causing us to enter into transactions or agreements that are not in the best interests of all stockholders. We are a “controlled company” within the meaning of the New York Stock Exchange Rules, and we take, and intend to continue to take, advantage of exemptions from certain corporate governance requirements. David C. Paul, alone, and our management, directors and significant stockholders, collectively, beneficially own a majority of the voting power of our outstanding common stock. Under the New York Stock Exchange Rules, a company of which more than 50% of the voting power is held by an individual, group or another company is a “controlled company” and may elect not to comply with certain corporate governance requirements, including the requirement that a majority of our directors be independent, as defined in the New York Stock Exchange Rules, and the requirement that our compensation and nominating and corporate governance committees consist entirely of independent directors. We rely, and intend to continue to rely, on the “controlled company” exemption under the New York Stock Exchange Rules. As a result, a majority of the members of our Board may not be independent directors and our nominating and corporate governance and compensation committees will not consist entirely of independent directors. Accordingly, while we remain a controlled company and during any transition period following a time when we are no longer a controlled company, you will not have the same protections afforded to stockholders of companies that are subject to all of the New York Stock Exchange’s corporate governance requirements. Our Board is authorized to issue and designate shares of our preferred stock in additional series without stockholder approval. Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation authorizes our Board, without the approval of our stockholders, to issue 35 million shares of our preferred stock, subject to limitations prescribed by applicable law, rules and regulations and the provisions of our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, as shares of preferred stock in series, and to establish from time to time the number of shares to be included in each such series, and to fix the designation, powers, preferences and rights of the shares of each such series and the qualifications, limitations or restrictions thereof. The powers, preferences and rights of these additional series of preferred stock may be senior to or on parity with our Class A common stock, which may reduce its value. Anti-takeover provisions in our organizational documents and Delaware law may discourage or prevent a change of control, even if an acquisition would be beneficial to our stockholders, which could depress the price of our Class A common stock and prevent attempts by our stockholders to replace or remove our current management. Our amended and restated certificate of incorporation and amended and restated bylaws contain other provisions that could delay or prevent a change of control of our company or changes in our Board that our stockholders might consider favorable. 42 Table of Contents In addition, we are subject to the provisions of Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law regulating corporate takeovers, which may restrict or prohibit certain business combination transactions with stockholders owning 15% or more of our outstanding voting stock, including discouraging takeover attempts that might result in a premium over the market price for shares of our Class A common stock. Section 203 and other provisions in our amended and restated certificate of incorporation, amended and restated bylaws and Delaware law could make it more difficult for stockholders or potential acquirers to obtain control of our Board or initiate actions that are opposed by our then-current Board, including delay or impede a merger, tender offer, or proxy contest involving our company. The existence of these provisions could negatively affect the price of our Class A common stock and limit opportunities for you to realize value in a corporate transaction. General Risk Factors If we do not successfully implement our business strategy, our business and results of operations will be adversely affected. Our business strategy was formed based on assumptions that might prove wrong. We believe that various demographics and industry-specific trends will help drive growth in our markets and our business, but these demographics and trends are uncertain. Actual demand for our products could differ materially from projected demand if our assumptions regarding these factors prove to be incorrect or do not materialize, or if alternative treatments to those offered by our products gain widespread acceptance. We may not be able to successfully implement our business strategy. To implement our business strategy, we need to, among other things, strengthen our brand, develop and introduce new musculoskeletal surgery products, find new applications for and improve our existing products, obtain regulatory clearance or approval for new products and applications and educate surgeons about the clinical and cost benefits of our products, all of which we believe could increase acceptance of our products by surgeons. Our strategy of focusing exclusively on the medical devices market may limit our ability to grow. In addition, we are seeking to increase our sales and, in order to do so, will need to commercialize additional products and expand our direct and distributor sales forces in existing and new territories, all of which could result in our becoming subject to additional or different domestic and foreign regulatory requirements, with which we may not be able to comply. Moreover, even if we successfully implement our business strategy, our operating results may not improve or may decline. We may decide to alter or discontinue aspects of our business strategy and may adopt different strategies due to business or competitive factors not currently foreseen, such as new medical technologies that would make our products obsolete. Any failure to implement our business strategy may adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition. If we fail to properly manage our anticipated growth, our business could suffer. Our rapid growth has placed, and will continue to place, a significant strain on our management and on our operational and financial resources and systems. Failure to manage our growth effectively could cause us to over-invest or under-invest in infrastructure, and result in losses or weaknesses in our infrastructure, which could materially adversely affect us. Additionally, our anticipated growth will increase the demands placed on our suppliers, resulting in an increased need for us to carefully monitor for quality assurance. Any failure by us to manage our growth effectively could have an adverse effect on our ability to achieve our development and commercialization goals. Fluctuations in insurance cost and availability could adversely affect our profitability or our risk management profile. We hold a number of insurance policies, including product liability insurance, directors’ and officers’ liability insurance, property insurance, health insurance and workers’ compensation insurance. If the costs of maintaining adequate insurance coverage increase significantly in the future, our operating results could be materially adversely affected. Likewise, if any of our current insurance coverage should become unavailable to us or become economically impractical, we would be required to operate our business without indemnity from commercial insurance providers. If we operate our business without insurance, we could be responsible for paying claims or judgments against us that would have otherwise been covered by insurance, which could adversely affect our results of operations or financial condition. We are exposed to the credit risk of some of our customers, which could result in material losses. Our business is subject to the risk of nonpayment by our customers. We sell our Enabling Technologies products through various credit and installment payment arrangements. We may experience loss from a customer’s failure to make payments according to the contractual terms. 43 Table of Contents Although we have systems in place to monitor and mitigate the associated risk, there can be no assurance that such systems will be effective in reducing the credit risk relating to the sale of our Enabling Technologies products. If the level of credit losses we experience in the future exceed our expectations, such losses could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition or results of operations. The widespread outbreak of a communicable disease, or any other public health crisis, could adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations. We could be negatively affected by the widespread outbreak of a communicable disease, or any other public health crisis that results in disruptions to hospitals and other healthcare facilities. A novel strain of coronavirus was first identified in Wuhan, China in December 2019, and the disease caused by it, COVID-19, was subsequently declared a pandemic by the World Health Organization in March 2020. The preventative and precautionary measures that hospitals and federal, state, local, and international governments took to mitigate the spread of the disease led to restrictions on, disruptions in, and other related impacts on elective procedure rates. On May 5, 2023 the World Health Organization declared the end of the COVID-19 pandemic as a public health emergency. The worldwide supply chain disruption relating to the COVID-19 pandemic resulted in delays and component shortages that impacted and may continue to impact our ability to manufacture our products by extending our lead times. These disruptions, or disruptions from future pandemics, among other things, may continue to impact our ability to satisfy customer demand, which could negatively impact our results of operations. Most jurisdictions have relaxed restrictions and resumed business operations, but a resurgence in infections or mutations of the coronavirus that causes COVID-19 could cause governments, hospitals, public institutions, or other authorities to reinstate such restrictions or impose additional restrictions. If a resurgence occurs, or a new pandemic arises, and governments mandate restrictions, including restrictions on elective surgeries, we expect that it could have a material adverse impact on our revenue growth, operating profit and cash flow, leading to revised payment terms with certain of our customers, and could change the effective tax rate driven by changes in the mix of earnings across the Company’s jurisdictions. Risks Relating to the Integration of NuVasive Integrating the NuVasive business into Globus may be more difficult, costly or time-consuming than expected and the Company may fail to realize the anticipated benefits of the Merger, which may adversely affect the Company’s business results and negatively affect the value of the Company’s common stock. The success of the Merger will depend on, among other things, our ability to realize the anticipated synergies, efficiencies and other benefits from combining the businesses of Globus and NuVasive. This success will depend on, among other factors, our ability to successfully integrate the Company’s business with the business of NuVasive. If we are not able to successfully integrate NuVasive’s business into the Company within the anticipated timeframe, or at all, the anticipated synergies, efficiencies and other benefits of the Merger may not be realized fully, or at all, or may take longer to realize than expected. An inability to realize the full extent of the anticipated benefits of the Merger, as well as any delays encountered in the integration process, could have an adverse effect upon the revenues, level of expenses and operating results of the Company, which may adversely affect the value of the common stock of the Company. There can be no assurances that the NuVasive business can be integrated successfully. It is possible that the integration process could result in the loss of key employees, the loss of customers, the disruption of the Company’s business, inconsistencies in standards, controls, procedures and policies, unexpected integration issues, higher than expected integration costs and an overall post-Merger integration process that takes longer than originally anticipated. The challenges involved in this integration, which will be complex and time-consuming, include the following: (cid:0) combining the businesses of Globus and NuVasive, including respective operations and corporate functions, and meeting the capital requirements of the Company in a manner that permits the Company to achieve any revenue synergies or efficiencies anticipated to result from the Merger, the failure of which would result in the anticipated benefits of the Merger not being realized in the timeframe currently anticipated or at all; (cid:0) integrating and retaining personnel from the two companies while continuing to provide consistent, high-quality products and services to customers; (cid:0) integrating each company’s technologies and technologies licensed by them from third parties; (cid:0) identifying and eliminating redundant and underperforming functions and assets; 44 Table of Contents (cid:0) harmonizing each company’s operating practices, employee development and compensation programs, financial reporting, internal controls and other policies, procedures and processes; (cid:0) maintaining existing agreements with each company’s business partners, surgeons, suppliers and vendors, avoiding delays in entering into new agreements with prospective business partners, surgeons, suppliers and vendors, and leveraging relationships with such third parties for the benefit of the Company; (cid:0) addressing possible differences in business backgrounds, corporate cultures and management philosophies; (cid:0) consolidating each company’s administrative and information technology infrastructure; (cid:0) combining the companies’ research and development functions; (cid:0) integrating and unifying the products and services available to historical Globus and NuVasive customers; (cid:0) coordinating sales activities and go-to-market efforts; (cid:0) managing the movement of certain positions to different locations; (cid:0) coordinating geographically dispersed organizations; (cid:0) managing the operations of a significantly larger and more complex company; and (cid:0) effecting actions that may be required in connection with obtaining regulatory or other governmental approvals. In addition, at times the attention of certain members of the Company’s management and resources may be focused on the integration of the businesses of the two companies and diverted from day-to-day business operations or other opportunities that may have been beneficial to such company, which may disrupt each company’s ongoing business and the business of the Company. The Company expects to incur substantial expenses related to the integration of NuVasive and may be unable to realize the anticipated synergies, which could adversely affect the Company’s business, financial condition and results of operations. The Company’s ability to achieve estimated synergies in the timeframe anticipated, or at all, is subject to various assumptions, which may or may not prove to be accurate. As a consequence, the Company may not be able to realize all of these synergies within the timeframe expected or at all. In addition, the Company may incur additional or unexpected costs in order to realize these benefits. Failure to achieve the expected synergies could significantly reduce the expected benefits associated with the Merger. Certain contractual counterparties may seek to modify contractual relationships with the Company, which could have an adverse effect on the Company’s business and operations. As a result of the Merger, the Company may experience impacts on relationships with contractual counterparties (such as business partners, surgeons, vendors, sales representatives, contractors, distributors or other third-party service providers) that may harm the Company’s business and results of operations. Certain counterparties may seek to terminate or modify contractual obligations following the Merger whether or not contractual rights are triggered as a result of the Merger. There can be no guarantee that Globus’s or NuVasive’s contractual counterparties will remain with or continue to have a relationship with the Company or do so on the same or similar contractual terms following the Merger. If any contractual counterparties (such as business partners, surgeons, vendors, sales representatives, contractors, distributors or other third-party service providers) seek to terminate or modify contractual obligations or discontinue their respective relationships with the Company, then the Company’s business and results of operations may be harmed. The Company may be exposed to increased litigation, which could have an adverse effect on the Company’s business and operations. The Company may be exposed to increased litigation from stockholders, customers, partners, suppliers, contractors and other third parties due to the Merger of Globus’s and NuVasive’s businesses. Such litigation may have an adverse impact on the Company’s business and results of operations or may cause disruptions to the Company’s operations. 45 Table of Contents Item 1B. Unresolved Staff Comments None. Item 1C. Cybersecurity Risk Management, Strategy, Governance, and Incident Disclosure We have processes in place for assessing, identifying, and managing material risks from cybersecurity threats, including potential unauthorized occurrences on or through both, our physical systems and electronic information systems, that could adversely affect the confidentiality, integrity, or availability of our information systems or the information residing on those systems. These include a wide variety of mechanisms, controls, technologies, methods, systems, and other processes that are designed to prevent, detect, or mitigate data loss, theft, misuse, unauthorized access, or other security incidents or vulnerabilities affecting the data. The data include confidential, proprietary, and business and personal information that we collect, process and store as part of our business, including on behalf of third parties. Additionally, we use processes to oversee and identify material risks from cybersecurity threats associated with our use of third-party technology and systems, including: technology and systems we use for encryption and authentication; employee email; content delivery to customers; back-office support; and other functions. As part of our risk management process, we conduct application security assessments, vulnerability management, penetration testing, security audits, and ongoing risk assessments. We also maintain a variety of incident response plans that are utilized when incidents are detected. We require employees with access to information systems, including all corporate employees, to undertake data protection and cybersecurity training and compliance programs at least annually. We have a unified and centrally-coordinated team, led by our Senior Vice President of Corporate Quality and IT, that is responsible for implementing and maintaining centralized cybersecurity and data protection practices at Globus in close coordination with senior leadership and other teams across Globus. Reporting to our Senior Vice president of Corporate Quality and IT are a number of trained information security professionals. In addition to our extensive in-house cybersecurity capabilities, at times we also engage assessors, consultants, auditors, or other third parties to assist with assessing, identifying and managing cybersecurity risks. Our cybersecurity risks and associated mitigations are evaluated by senior leadership, including as part of our risk assessments that are reviewed by the Audit Committee and our Board of Directors. Additional information about cybersecurity threats we face is discussed in Item 1A of Part I, “Risk Factors,” under the heading “We are subject to data privacy laws and our failure to comply with them could subject us to substantial liabilities,” which should be read in conjunction with the information above. The Board of Directors, which is comprised of independent directors, oversees our policies and procedures for protecting our cybersecurity infrastructure and for compliance with applicable data protection and security regulations, and related risks. They receive reports regarding such risks from management, including our Senior Vice President of Corporate Quality and IT. They also oversee the response to any significant cybersecurity incidents. Our Senior Vice President of Corporate Quality and IT, who has extensive cybersecurity knowledge and skills gained from over 20 years of work experience, heads the team responsible for implementing and maintaining cybersecurity and data protection practices at Globus and reports directly to the Chief Operating Officer. Item 2. Properties Our owned corporate headquarters are located in Audubon, Pennsylvania. We have additional leased domestic administrative offices, research and training facilities in Arizona, California, Colorado, Illinois, Maryland, New Jersey North Carolina and Texas (one facility in Texas is owned). Our owned manufacturing and fulfillment facilities are located in Massachusetts, Ohio, Pennsylvania and Tennessee. We maintain leased distribution warehouses and administrative offices in seventeen additional countries. Item 3. Legal Proceedings We are involved in a number of proceedings, legal actions and claims. Such matters are subject to many uncertainties, and the outcomes of these matters are not within our control and may not be known for prolonged periods of time. In some actions, the claimants seek damages, as well as other relief, including injunctions prohibiting us from engaging in certain activities, which, if granted, could require significant expenditures and/or result in lost revenues. For further details on the material legal proceedings to which we are currently a party, please refer to “Part II; Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data; Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements; Note 15. Commitments and Contingencies” below. In addition, we are subject to legal proceedings arising in the ordinary course of business. Item 4. Mine Safety Disclosures Not applicable. 46 Table of Contents PART II Item 5. Market for the Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities Class A Common Stock Our Class A common stock trades on The New York Stock Exchange, under the symbol “GMED.” We had approximately 65 stockholders of record as of February 16, 2024. We believe that the number of beneficial owners is substantially greater than the number of record holders because a large portion of our Class A common stock is held of record through brokerage firms in “street name.” Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities None. Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities We repurchase shares of the Company’s Class A common stock pursuant to the publicly announced share repurchase program authorized by the Board of Directors in March 2020 and the expansion of the stock repurchase plan authorized by the Board of Directors in March 2022. On September 27, 2023, the share repurchase program was expanded by authorizing the Company to repurchase an additional $350.0 million of the Company’s Class A common stock. The following table provides the activity related to share repurchases for the fourth quarter of 2023. (In thousands except for per share prices) Period October 1, 2023 - October 31, 2023 November 1, 2023 - November 30, 2023 December 1, 2023 - December 31, 2023 Total Total number of shares purchased (a) Average price paid per share (b) Total number of shares purchased as part of publicly announced plans or programs (a) Approximate dollar value of shares that may yet be purchased under the plans or programs (a) 2,829 $ — 1,500 4,329 53.31 — 49.85 2,829 $ — 1,500 4,329 350,001 350,001 275,239 (a) On March 11, 2020, our Board of Directors authorized a share repurchase program that allows for the repurchase up to $200 million of the Company’s Class A common stock. On March 4, 2022, our Board of Directors authorized the expansion of the share repurchase program of the Company’s Class A common stock by an additional $200 million. On September 27, 2023, the share repurchase program was expanded by authorizing the Company to repurchase an additional $350.0 million of the Company’s Class A common stock. The shares may be purchased through privately negotiated or open market transactions. This program has no time limit and may be suspended for periods or discontinued at any time. (b) Inclusive of an immaterial amount of commission fees. Dividend Policy We have never declared or paid any cash dividends on our capital stock. We currently intend to retain future earnings, if any, for development of our business and do not anticipate that we will declare or pay cash dividends on our capital stock in the foreseeable future. 47 Table of Contents Comparative Stock Performance Graph The following graph illustrates a comparison of the total cumulative stockholder return on our Class A common stock from December 31, 2018 through December 31, 2023 to two indices: the S&P 500 Index and the S&P 500 Health Care Equipment Index. The graph assumes an initial investment of $100 on December 31, 2018, in each of our Class A common stock, the stocks comprising the S&P 500 Index, and the stocks comprising the S&P 500 Health Care Equipment Index, including reinvestment of dividends, if any. Historical stockholder return is not necessarily indicative of the performance to be expected for any future periods. The following graph and related information shall not be deemed “soliciting material” or to be “filed” with the SEC, nor shall such information be incorporated by reference into any future filing, except to the extent that we specifically incorporate it by reference into such filing. Company/Index Globus Medical, Inc. S&P 500 Index S&P 500 Health Care Equipment 2018 $100 $100 $100 December 31, 2020 $151 $156 $152 2021 $167 $200 $182 2022 $172 $164 $147 2023 $123 $207 $161 2019 $136 $131 $129 48 Table of Contents Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations The following discussion and analysis of our financial condition and results of operations should be read together with our consolidated financial statements and related notes included elsewhere in this Annual Report. This discussion and analysis contains forward-looking statements that involve risks, uncertainties and assumptions. You should review the “Risk Factors” and “Cautionary Note Concerning Forward-Looking Statements” sections of this Annual Report for a discussion of certain of the important factors that could cause actual results to differ materially from the results described in or implied by the forward-looking statements described in the following discussion and analysis. Certain amounts and percentages in this discussion and analysis have been rounded for convenience of presentation. Overview We are an engineering-driven company with a history of rapidly developing and commercializing advanced products and procedures to address treatment challenges. With numerous products launched since the founding of the Company, including 10 products launched on the market in 2023, we offer a comprehensive portfolio of innovative and differentiated technologies that treat a variety of musculoskeletal conditions. We separate our products and services into two major categories: Musculoskeletal Solutions and Enabling Technologies. NuVasive Merger On September 1, 2023, pursuant to that certain Merger Agreement with NuVasive and Merger Sub, Merger Sub, a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, merged with and into NuVasive, with NuVasive surviving as a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company. Under the Merger Agreement, each share of common stock, par value $0.001 per share, of NuVasive issued and outstanding immediately prior to the effective time of the Merger (other than certain excluded shares as described in the Merger Agreement) was cancelled and converted into the right to receive 0.75 fully paid and non-assessable shares of Class A common stock of Globus, $0.001 par value per share, and the right to receive cash in lieu of fractional shares. Product & Service Categories While we group our products and services into two categories, Musculoskeletal Solutions and Enabling Technologies, they are not limited to a particular technology, platform or surgical approach. Instead, our goal is to offer a comprehensive product suite that can be used to safely and effectively treat patients based on their specific anatomy and condition, and is customized to the surgeon’s training and surgical preference. Musculoskeletal Solutions Our Musculoskeletal Solutions consist primarily of implantable devices, biologics, accessories, unique surgical instruments, and neuromonitoring services, used in an expansive range of spinal, orthopedic and neurosurgical procedures. Musculoskeletal disorders are a leading driver of healthcare costs worldwide. Disorders range in severity from mild pain and loss of feeling to extreme pain and paralysis. These disorders are primarily caused by degenerative and congenital conditions, deformity, tumors and traumatic injuries. Treatment alternatives for musculoskeletal disorders range from non- operative conservative therapies to surgical interventions depending on the pathology. Conservative therapies include bed rest, medication, casting, bracing, and physical therapy. When conservative therapies are not indicated, or fail to provide adequate quality of life improvements, surgical interventions may be used. Surgical treatments for musculoskeletal disorders can be instrumented, which include the use of implants, or non-instrumented, which forego the use of hardware but may include biologics. Neuromonitoring services use proprietary software-driven nerve detection and avoidance technology and include IONM to aid spine surgery. Enabling Technologies Our Enabling Technologies are comprised of INR solutions for assisted surgery which are advanced computer-assisted intelligent systems designed to enhance a surgeon’s capabilities, and ultimately improve patient care and reduce radiation exposure for all involved, by streamlining surgical procedures to be safer, less invasive, and more accurate. The market for our Enabling Technologies in spine and orthopedic surgery is still in the infancy stage and consists primarily of imaging, navigation and robotic systems. In spine, a majority of these technologies are limited to surgical planning and assistance in implant placement for increased accuracy and time savings with less intraoperative radiation exposure to the patient and surgical staff. As our Enabling Technologies become more fully integrated with our Musculoskeletal Solutions, a continued rise in adoption is expected. Furthermore, we believe as new technologies such as augmented reality and artificial intelligence are introduced, Enabling Technologies have the potential to transform the way surgery is performed and most importantly, continue to improve patient outcomes. 49 Table of Contents Geographic Information To date, the primary market for our products has been the U.S., where we sell our products through a combination of direct sales representatives employed by us and distributor sales representatives employed by exclusive independent distributors, who distribute our products for a commission that is generally based on a percentage of sales. We believe there is significant opportunity to strengthen our position in the U.S. market by increasing the size of our U.S. sales force and we intend to add additional direct and distributor sales representatives in the future. During the year ended December 31, 2023, international net sales accounted for approximately 18.4% of our total net sales. We have sold our products in approximately 64 countries other than the U.S. through a combination of sales representatives employed by us and exclusive international distributors. We believe there are significant opportunities for us to increase our presence in both existing and new international markets through the continued expansion of our direct and distributor sales forces and through the commercialization of additional products. Seasonality Our business is generally not seasonal in nature. However, sales of our Musculoskeletal Solutions products and services may be influenced by summer vacation and winter holiday periods during which we have experienced fewer surgeries taking place, as well as more surgeries taking place later in the year when patients have met the deductibles under insurance plans. Sales of our Enabling Technologies products may be influenced by longer capital purchase cycles and the timing of budget approvals for major capital purchases. Components of our Results of Operations We manage our business globally within two operating segments, which is consistent with how our management reviews our business, makes investment and resource allocation decisions and assesses operating performance. We have concluded that these operating segments are aggregated into one reportable segment, based on the aggregation criteria. Net Sales We sell implants and related disposables, primarily to hospitals, for use by surgeons to treat musculoskeletal disorders. We generally place surgical sets, which contain our implants, disposables, surgical instruments and cases, in the field with our sales representatives, and the surgical sets are maintained either with our sales representatives or at our hospital customers that purchase the surgical sets used in surgeries. We recognize revenue when the implants and related disposables have been implanted or used in a surgery, or for sets that are sold directly, when title to the goods and risk of loss are transferred to the customer and there are no remaining performance obligations which affect the customer’s final acceptance of the sale. We generally recognize INR solutions revenue when control transfers to the customer based on the terms of the arrangement, which typically occurs at the time the product is shipped or delivered. Depending on the terms of the arrangement, we may also defer the recognition of a portion of the consideration as we satisfy future performance obligations related to the provision of maintenance and support. Cost of Sales While we have increased our in-house implant product manufacturing capacity and assemble our INR systems in-house, we also have products manufactured by third-party suppliers. Substantially all of our suppliers manufacture our products in the U.S. Our cost of sales consists primarily of costs from our in-house manufacturing, costs of products purchased from third-party suppliers, excess and obsolete inventory charges, depreciation of surgical instruments and cases, royalties, shipping, inspection and related costs incurred in making our products available for sale or use. Research and Development Expenses Research and development expenses primarily consist of engineering, product development, clinical and regulatory expenses, consulting services, outside prototyping services, internal and external research activities, materials, depreciation, and other costs associated with development of our products. Research and development expenses also include personnel and consultants’ compensation, stock-based compensation expense, and acquired research in process with no alternative future use. We expense research and development costs as they are incurred. We expect to incur additional research and development costs as we continue to develop new products. These costs will increase in absolute terms as we continue to expand our product pipeline and add personnel. 50 Table of Contents Selling, General and Administrative Expenses Selling, general and administrative expenses primarily consist of salaries, benefits and other related costs, including stock-based compensation, for personnel employed in sales, marketing, finance, legal, compliance, administrative, information technology, medical education and training, quality and human resource departments. Our selling, general and administrative expenses also include commissions, generally based on a percentage of sales, to direct sales representatives and distributors. We expect selling, general and administrative expenses will increase in absolute terms with the continued expansion of our sales force and commercialization of our current and pipeline products. We plan to hire more personnel to support the growth of our business. Provision for Litigation We record a provision for litigation settlements when a loss is known or considered probable and the amount can be reasonably estimated and in the case of a favorable settlement, income when realized. Amortization of Intangibles We amortize finite lived intangible assets over the period of estimated benefit using the straight-line method. Indefinite lived intangible assets are tested for impairment annually or whenever events or circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of the asset (asset group) may not be recoverable. If impairment is indicated, we measure the amount of the impairment loss as the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds the fair value of the asset. Fair value is generally determined using a discounted future cash flow analysis. Acquisition-Related Costs Acquisition-related costs represent the change in fair value of business acquisition-related contingent consideration and specific costs related to the consummation of the acquisition process such as banker fees, legal fees and other acquisition-related professional fees. Income Tax Provision We are taxed at the rates applicable within each jurisdiction. The composite income tax rate, tax provisions, deferred tax assets and deferred tax liabilities will vary according to the jurisdiction in which profits arise. Tax laws are complex and subject to different interpretations by management and the respective governmental taxing authorities, and require us to exercise judgment in determining our income tax provision, our deferred tax assets and liabilities, and the valuation allowance recorded against our net deferred tax assets. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined using the enacted tax rates in effect for the years in which those tax assets are expected to be realized. A valuation allowance is established when it is more likely than not that the future realization of all or some of the deferred tax assets will not be achieved. Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates The preparation of the consolidated financial statements requires us to make assumptions, estimates and judgments that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, the disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities as of the date of the consolidated financial statements, and the reported amounts of sales and expenses during the reporting periods. Certain of our more critical accounting policies require the application of significant judgment by management in selecting the appropriate assumptions for calculating financial estimates. By their nature, these judgments are subject to an inherent degree of uncertainty. On an ongoing basis, we evaluate our judgments, including but not limited to those related to inventories, recoverability of long-lived assets and the fair value of our common stock. We use historical experience and other assumptions as the basis for our judgments and making these estimates. Because future events and their effects cannot be determined with precision, actual results could differ significantly from these estimates. Any changes in those estimates will be reflected in our consolidated financial statements as they occur. While our significant accounting policies are more fully described in “Part II; Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data; Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements; Note 2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies” below in this Annual Report, we believe that the following accounting policies and estimates are most critical to a full understanding and evaluation of our reported financial results. The critical accounting policies addressed below reflect our most significant judgments and estimates used in the preparation of our consolidated financial statements. We have reviewed these critical accounting policies with the audit committee of our Board. Revenue Recognition. Revenue is recognized upon transfer of control of promised products or services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration we expect to receive in exchange for those products or services. Sales and other taxes we collect concurrent with revenue-producing activities are excluded from revenue. For purposes of disclosure, we disaggregate our revenue into two categories, Musculoskeletal Solutions and Enabling Technologies. 51 Table of Contents Our Musculoskeletal Solutions products consist primarily of the implantable devices, disposables, unique instruments, and neuromonitoring services used in an expansive range of spine, orthopedic trauma, hip, knee and extremity procedures. The majority of our Musculoskeletal Solutions contracts have a single performance obligation and revenue is recognized at a point in time. For our IONM services, revenue is recognized in the period the service is performed for the amount of consideration expected to be received. Our Enabling Technologies products are advanced hardware and software systems, and related technologies, that are designed to enhance a surgeon’s capabilities and streamline surgical procedures by making them less invasive, more accurate, and more reproducible to improve patient care. The majority of our Enabling Technologies product contracts contain multiple performance obligations, including maintenance and support, and revenue is recognized as we fulfill each performance obligation. When contracts have multiple performance obligations, we allocate the contract’s transaction price to each performance obligation using our best estimate of the standalone selling price of each distinct good or service in the contract. Our policy is to classify shipping and handling costs billed to customers as sales and the related expenses as cost of sales. Excess and Obsolete Inventory. Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or net realizable value. Cost is determined on a first-in, first-out basis. The majority of our inventory is finished goods and we utilize both in-house manufacturing and third-party suppliers to produce our products. We periodically evaluate the carrying value of our inventories in relation to our estimated forecast of product demand, which takes into consideration the estimated life cycle of product releases. When quantities on hand exceed estimated sales forecasts, we record a write-down for such excess inventories. Once inventory has been written down, it creates a new cost basis for inventory that is not subsequently written up. The need to maintain substantial levels of inventory increases the risk of carrying excess inventory. Many of our Musculoskeletal Solutions products come in sets which feature components in a variety of sizes so that the implant or device may be customized to the patient’s needs. In order to market our Musculoskeletal Solutions products effectively, we must often maintain and provide surgeons and hospitals with surgical sets, back-up products and products of different sizes. For each surgery, fewer than all of the components of the set are used, and therefore certain portions of the set may be considered excess inventory since they are not likely to be used. One of our primary business goals is to focus on continual product innovation. Though we believe this provides us with a competitive advantage, it also increases the risk that our products will become excess or obsolete inventory prior to sale or prior to the end of their anticipated useful lives. When we introduce new products or next-generation products, we may be required to take charges for excess and obsolete inventory that have a significant impact on the value of our inventory or on our operating results. Fair Value Measurements. Fair value is defined as the price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset or the liability in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date. Additionally, a fair value hierarchy was established that prioritizes the inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value. The hierarchy gives the highest priority to unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs. The level within the fair value hierarchy is based on the lowest level of any input that is significant to the fair value measurement. Our assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis are classified and disclosed in one of the following three categories: Level 1—quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets and liabilities; Level 2—observable inputs other than quoted prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities; and Level 3—unobservable inputs in which there is little or no market data available, which require the reporting entity to use significant unobservable inputs or valuation techniques. Contingent consideration represents contingent milestone, performance or revenue-sharing payment obligations related to acquisitions and is measured at fair value, based on significant inputs that are not observable in the market, which represents a Level 3 measurement within the fair value hierarchy. The valuation of contingent consideration uses assumptions we believe would be made by a market participant. We assess these assumptions on an ongoing basis as additional data impacting the assumptions is obtained. The fair value of contingent consideration is recorded in business acquisition liabilities on our consolidated balance sheets, and changes in the fair value of contingent consideration are recognized in acquisition-related costs in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income. The fair value of contingent restricted stock unit grants (“RSUs”) are recorded as additional paid-in capital in the consolidated balance sheet on the day of the grant due to the remote likelihood of forfeiture. The purchase price of business acquisitions is primarily allocated to the tangible and identifiable intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed based on their estimated fair values on the acquisition date, with the excess recorded as goodwill. We utilize Level 3 inputs in the determination of the initial fair value. 52 Table of Contents Goodwill and Intangible Assets. Goodwill represents the excess of purchase price over the fair values of the identifiable assets acquired less the liabilities assumed in the acquisition of a business. Goodwill is tested for impairment at least annually or whenever events or circumstances indicate that a carrying amount may be impaired. We perform our goodwill impairment analysis at the reporting unit level. We perform our annual impairment analysis by either comparing a reporting unit’s estimated fair value to its carrying amount or doing a qualitative assessment of a reporting unit’s fair value from the last quantitative assessment to determine if there is potential impairment. We may do a qualitative assessment when the results of the previous quantitative test indicated the reporting unit’s estimated fair value was significantly in excess of the carrying value of its net assets and we do not believe there have been significant changes in the reporting unit’s operations that would significantly decrease its estimated fair value or significantly increase its net assets. If a quantitative assessment is performed, the evaluation includes management estimates of discounted cash flow projections based on internal future projections and/or use of a market approach by looking at market values of comparable companies. We perform our annual impairment test of goodwill in the fourth quarter of each year. Intangible assets consist of purchased in-process research and development (“IPR&D”), developed technology, supplier network, patents, customer relationships, re-acquired rights, and non-compete agreements. Intangible assets with finite useful lives are amortized over the period of estimated benefit using the straight-line method and estimated useful lives ranging from one to twenty-one years. Intangible assets are tested for impairment annually or whenever events or circumstances indicate that a carrying amount of an asset (asset group) may not be recoverable. If an impairment is indicated, we measure the amount of the impairment loss as the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds the fair value of the asset. Fair value is generally determined using a discounted future cash flow analysis. IPR&D has an indefinite life and is not amortized until completion of the project at which time the IPR&D becomes an amortizable asset. If the related project is not completed in a timely manner, we may have an impairment related to the IPR&D, calculated as the excess of the asset’s carrying value over its fair value. During the twelve months ended December 31, 2023, there were no impairments in goodwill, finite-lived intangible assets, or IPR&D. Long-Lived Assets. We periodically evaluate the recoverability of the carrying amount of long-lived assets, which include property and equipment, as well as whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset group may not be fully recoverable. An impairment is assessed when the undiscounted future cash flows from the use and eventual disposition of an asset group are less than its carrying value. If an impairment is indicated, we measure the amount of the impairment loss as the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds the fair value of the asset group. Our fair value methodology is based on quoted market prices, if available. If quoted market prices are not available, an estimate of fair value is made based on prices of similar assets or other valuation techniques including present value techniques. During the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021, we did not record any impairment charges related to long-lived assets. Stock-Based Compensation Expense. The cost of employee and non-employee director awards is measured at the grant date fair value of the award and is recognized as expense over the requisite service period, which is generally the vesting period of the equity award. Compensation expense for awards includes the impact of forfeiture in the period when they occur. We estimate the fair value of stock options utilizing the Black-Scholes option-pricing model. Inputs to the Black-Scholes model include our stock price, expected volatility, expected term, risk-free interest rate and expected dividends. Expected volatility is based on the historical volatility of the Company’s common stock over the most recent period commensurate with the estimated expected term of the Company’s stock options offering period which is derived from historical experience. The risk-free interest rate assumption is based on observed interest rates of U.S. Treasury securities appropriate for the expected terms of the stock options. The dividend yield assumption is based on the history and expectation of no dividend payouts. The fair value of restricted stock units is estimated on the day of grant based on the closing price of the Company’s common stock. We assumed equity-classified awards for certain NuVasive RSUs, and performance restricted stock units (“PRSUs”), as part of the Merger. These RSUs and PRSUs are measured at the grant date based on the estimated fair value of the award. The fair value of equity instruments that are expected to vest is recognized and amortized over the requisite service period. The Company has granted awards with up to five year graded or cliff vesting terms (in each case, with service through the date of vesting being required). No exercise price or other monetary payment is required for receipt of the shares issued in settlement of the respective award; instead, consideration is furnished in the form of the participant’s service to the Company. We expect to continue to grant stock-based awards in the future, and to the extent that we do, our actual stock-based compensation expense recognized may increase. Legal Proceedings. We are involved in a number of proceedings, legal actions, and claims. Such matters are subject to many uncertainties, and the outcomes of these matters are not within our control and may not be known for prolonged periods of time. In some actions, the claimants seek damages, as well as other relief, including injunctions prohibiting us from engaging in certain activities, 53 Table of Contents which, if granted, could require significant expenditures and/or result in lost revenues. We record a liability in the consolidated financial statements for these actions when a loss is considered probable and the amount can be reasonably estimated. If the reasonable estimate of a probable loss is a range, and no amount within the range is a better estimate than any other, the minimum amount of the range is accrued. If a loss is reasonably possible but not known or probable, and can be reasonably estimated, the estimated loss or range of loss is disclosed. In most cases, significant judgment is required to estimate the amount and timing of a loss to be recorded. We expense legal costs related to loss contingencies as incurred. While it is not possible to predict the outcome for these matters, we believe it is possible that costs associated with them could have a material adverse impact on our consolidated earnings, financial position or cash flows. Income Taxes. We recognize deferred tax assets and liabilities for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. We measure deferred tax assets and liabilities using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the year in which such items are expected to be received or settled. We recognize the effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates in the period that includes the enactment date. We establish a valuation allowance to offset any deferred tax assets if, based upon available evidence, it is more likely than not that some or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. While we believe that our tax positions are fully supportable, there is a risk that certain positions could be challenged successfully. In these instances, we look to establish reserves. If we determine that a tax position is more likely than not of being sustained upon audit, based solely on the technical merits of the position, we recognize the benefit. We measure the benefit by determining the amount that has likelihood greater than 50% of being realized upon settlement. We presume that all tax positions will be examined by a taxing authority with full knowledge of all relevant information. We regularly monitor our tax positions, tax assets and tax liabilities. We reevaluate the technical merits of our tax positions and recognize an uncertain tax benefit or reverse a previously recorded tax benefit when (i) a tax audit is completed, (ii) applicable tax law, including a tax case or legislative guidance, changes or (iii) the statute of limitations expires. Significant judgment is required in accounting for tax reserves. Results of Operations Year Ended December 31, 2023 Compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2022 Net Sales The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, our net sales by geography expressed as dollar amounts and the changes in sales between the specified periods expressed in dollar amounts and as percentages: (In thousands, except percentages) United States International Total net sales Year Ended December 31, $ $ 2023 1,279,765 288,711 1,568,476 $ $ 2022 871,939 150,904 1,022,843 $ $ Change $ 407,826 137,807 545,633 % 46.8% 91.3% 53.3% In the U.S., the increase in net sales of $407.8 million was due primarily to the addition of NuVasive, as well as increased spine product sales, including robotic spine instruments, resulting from penetration in existing territories and an increase in sales volume of Enabling Technologies. International net sales increased by $137.8 million, which was due primarily due to the addition of NuVasive and increased spine product sales resulting from penetration in existing territories. Cost of Sales (In thousands, except percentages) Cost of sales Percentage of net sales Year Ended December 31, 2023 2022 $ 548,174 $ 34.9% 263,725 $ 25.8% Change $ 284,449 % 107.9% The increase of $284.4 million in cost of sales was primarily due to the addition of NuVasive, amortization of the inventory fair value step up, increased volume and product mix, higher write-downs of excess and obsolete inventory, and higher depreciation. These increases were partially offset by lower production variances. 54 Table of Contents Research and Development Expenses (In thousands, except percentages) Research and development Percentage of net sales Year Ended December 31, 2023 2022 $ 124,010 $ 7.9% 73,015 $ 7.1% Change $ 50,995 % 69.8% The increase of $51.0 million in research and development expenses was due primarily to the addition of NuVasive and an increase in personnel- related expenses due to our continued investment in product development. Selling, General and Administrative Expenses (In thousands, except percentages) Selling, general and administrative Percentage of net sales Year Ended December 31, 2023 2022 $ 643,410 $ 41.0% 432,117 $ 42.2% Change $ 211,293 % 48.9% The $211.3 million increase in selling, general and administrative expenses was due to the addition of NuVasive, and an increase in personnel- related expenses resulting primarily from higher product sales, and an increase in bad debt and meeting expenses. Provision for Litigation (In thousands, except percentages) Provision for litigation, net Percentage of net sales Year Ended December 31, 2023 2022 $ 434 $ 0.0% 2,341 $ 0.2% Change $ (1,907) % -81.5% The $1.9 million decrease in provision for litigation is due to a settlement receipt, partially offset by a settlement payment for the year ended December 31, 2023 compared to 2022. Amortization of Intangibles (In thousands, except percentages) Amortization of intangibles Percentage of net sales Year Ended December 31, 2023 2022 $ 51,032 $ 3.3% 17,735 $ 1.7% Change $ 33,297 % 187.7% The increase of $33.3 million in the amortization of intangibles is primarily due to the impact of the recognized intangibles in connection with the Merger. Acquisition-Related Costs (In thousands, except percentages) Acquisition-related costs Percentage of net sales Year Ended December 31, 2023 2022 $ 68,274 $ 4.4% 5,959 $ 0.6% Change $ 62,315 % 1045.7% The increase of $62.3 million in acquisition-related costs is due to costs incurred relating to the closing of the Merger, including investment banking, employee benefit and legal costs. It also includes an unfavorable change in fair value of business acquisition liabilities, driven by changes in market conditions and the achievement of certain performance conditions. Other Income/(expense), Net (In thousands, except percentages) Other income, net Percentage of net sales Year Ended December 31, 2023 2022 $ 32,251 $ 2.1% 15,068 $ 1.5% Change $ 17,183 % 114.0% 55 Table of Contents The increase of $17.2 million in other income, was primarily due to foreign currency exchange gains of $14.3 million in the current year compared to $1.0 million of foreign currency losses in the prior year and an increase of $5.9 million related to higher interest income yields on marketable securities from external market factors. Income Tax Provision (In thousands, except percentages) Income tax provision Effective income tax rate Year Ended December 31, 2023 2022 $ $ 42,520 25.7% $ 52,850 21.7% Change $ (10,330) % -19.5% The increase in the effective tax rate is primarily due to non-deductible compensation expenses and other non-deductible Merger-related transaction costs as a percentage of pretax earnings. A discussion of our Results of Operations for the year ended December 31, 2022 can be found in “Part II, Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations: Results of Operations; Year Ended December 31, 2022 Compared to the Year Ended December 31, 2021.” on our Form 10-K filed on February 21, 2023. Liquidity and Capital Resources Our principal source of liquidity is cash flow from operating activities as well as our cash and cash equivalents and marketable securities, which we believe will provide sufficient funding for us to meet our liquidity requirements for the foreseeable future. Our principal liquidity requirements are to fund working capital, research and development, including clinical trials, capital expenditures primarily related to investment in surgical sets required to maintain and expand our business, service our 2025 Notes, and potential future business or intellectual property acquisitions. We expect to continue to make investments in surgical sets as we launch new products, increase the size of our U.S. sales force, and expand into international markets. Additionally, we have varying needs for cash in connection with our Senior Convertible Notes, of which $450 million of Senior Convertible Notes are due March 2025, as well as for certain acquisition-related obligations and contingent consideration achievements. Future litigation or requirements to escrow funds could also materially impact our liquidity and our ability to invest in and operate our business on an ongoing basis. We may, however, require additional liquidity as we continue to execute our business strategy. To the extent that we require new sources of liquidity, we may consider incurring debt, including borrowing against our existing credit facility, convertible debt instruments, and/or raising additional funds through an equity offering. The sale of additional equity may result in dilution to our stockholders. There is no assurance that we will be able to secure such additional funding on terms acceptable to us, or at all. Line of Credit In September 2023, we entered into an unsecured credit agreement with U.S. Bank National Association, as administrative agent, Citizens Bank, N.A., as syndication agent, Royal Bank of Canada, as documentation agent, U.S. Bank National Association and Citizens Bank, N.A., as joint lead arrangers and joint book runners, and the other lenders referred to therein (the “September 2023 Credit Agreement”), that provides a revolving credit facility permitting borrowings up to $400.0 million and has a termination date of September 27, 2028. We may request an increase in the revolving commitments in an aggregate amount not to exceed (i) $200 million or (ii) so long as the Leverage Ratio (as defined in the September 2023 Credit Agreement) is at least 0.25 to 1.00 less than the applicable Leverage Ratio then required under the September 2023 Credit Agreement, an unlimited amount. Revolving Loans under the September 2023 Credit Agreement bear interest at either a base rate or the Term SOFR Rate (as defined in the Revolving Credit Facility) plus, in each case, an applicable margin, as determined in accordance with the provisions of the September 2023 Credit Agreement. The Applicable Margin ranges from 0.125% to 0.625% for the Base Rate and 1.125% to 1.625% for the Term SOFR Rate. We may also request Swingline Loans (as defined in the September 2023 Credit Agreement) at either the Base Rate or the Daily Term SOFR Rate. The September 2023 Credit Agreement is guaranteed by certain direct or indirect wholly owned subsidiaries of the Company. The September 2023 Credit Agreement contains financial and other customary covenants, including a funded net indebtedness to adjusted EBITDA ratio. As of December 31, 2023, we have not borrowed under the September 2023 Credit Agreement and we are in compliance with all covenants. 56 Table of Contents Contractual Obligations and Commitments In connection with the Merger, the Company acquired additional obligations and commitments, including, but not limited to (i) the 2025 Notes, with a principal balance of $450.0 million, (ii) contingent consideration arrangements associated with certain historical NuVasive acquisitions, and (iii) operating lease and finance lease obligations. Refer to the Notes to the consolidated financial statements for further description of our 2025 Notes (Note 11), contingent consideration arrangements (Notes 6 and 15), and lease obligations (Note 16). The following table summarizes our outstanding contractual obligations as of December 31, 2023. (In thousands) Convertible Notes Operating leases Financing Leases Contingent consideration Purchase obligations Total (2) * Payments Due by Period Total Less than 1 Year 1-3 Years 3-5 Years More than 5 Years $ $ 452,531 $ 144,350 850 46,137 6,429 650,297 $ 1,687 $ 18,336 498 43,137 4,629 68,287 $ 450,844 $ 28,362 352 1,000 1,700 482,258 $ — $ 23,634 — 1,000 100 24,734 $ — 74,018 — 1,000 — 75,018 (1) Reflects minimum annual volume commitments to purchase inventory under certain of our supplier contracts. (2) In connection with certain acquisitions completed in 2011 through 2023, we have certain contingent consideration obligations payable to the sellers in these transactions upon the achievement of certain regulatory and sales milestones. For further information, see Notes 3, and 6 to the consolidated financial statements in “Part II; Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.” * Excludes contributions to pension and other post-employment benefit plans, uncertain tax positions, non-current tax liabilities and royalty obligations for which we cannot make a reliable estimate of the period of cash settlement. For further information, see Notes 14, and 17 to the consolidated financial statements in “Part II; Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.” Cash Flows The following table summarizes, for the periods indicated, cash flows from operating, investing and financing activities: (In thousands) Net cash provided by/(used in) operating activities Net cash provided by/(used in) investing activities Net cash provided by/(used in) financing activities Effect of foreign exchange rate changes on cash Increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents Cash Provided by Operating Activities 2023 243,499 $ 302,968 (231,821) 2,180 316,826 $ $ $ Year Ended December 31, 2022 178,468 $ (110,362) (109,962) (747) (42,603) $ 2021 276,274 $ (375,939) 54,147 (810) (46,328) $ 2023-2022 Change $ 65,031 $ 413,330 (121,859) 2,927 359,429 $ 2022-2021 Change $ (97,806) 265,577 (164,109) 63 3,725 The higher net cash provided by operating activities for the year ended December 31, 2023 was primarily the result of higher net income after adjusting out non-cash add-backs and non-cash expenses, such as amortization of purchase accounting related fair value step up, amortization, and stock based compensation, partially offset by unfavorable change in deferred income taxes. Cash Used in Investing Activities The higher cash provided by investing activities for the year ended December 31, 2023 was primarily from net inflows of purchases, maturities, and sales of marketable securities, partially offset by acquisition of businesses net of cash acquired and higher purchases of property and equipment. Cash Provided by Financing Activities The higher net cash used in financing activities for the year ended December 31, 2023 was primarily the result of higher repurchases of Class A common stock and lower proceeds from exercise of stock options. A discussion of our cash flows for the year ended December 31, 2022 can be found in “Part II, Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations: Results of Operations; Cash Flows.” On our Form 10-K filed on February 21, 2023. 57 Table of Contents Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements For further details on recently issued accounting pronouncements, please refer to “Part II; Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data; Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements; Note 2. Summary of Significant Accounting Policies; (v) Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements.” 58 Table of Contents Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosure About Market Risk Market risk is the potential loss arising from adverse changes in the financial markets. We are exposed to various market risks, which may result in potential losses arising from adverse changes in market rates, such as interest rates and foreign exchange rates. We do not enter into derivatives or other financial instruments for trading or speculative purposes and do not believe we are exposed to material market risk with respect to our cash, cash equivalents and marketable debt securities. Market Price Risk In order to reduce the potential equity dilution associated with our convertible notes, we entered into transactions for convertible notes hedge (the “2025 Hedge”) in connection with the issuance in March 2020 of $450.0 million principal amount of unsecured senior convertible notes with a stated interest rate of 0.375% and a maturity date of March 15, 2025 (the “2025 Notes”), entitling us to purchase our common stock. Upon conversion of our convertible notes, the 2025 Hedge is expected to reduce the equity dilution if the daily volume-weighted average price per share of our common stock exceeds the strike price of the applicable hedge. We also entered into warrant transactions with the counterparties of the 2025 Hedge entitling them to acquire shares of our common stock. The warrant transactions could have a dilutive effect on our earnings per share to the extent that the price of our common stock during a given measurement period (the quarter or year to date period) exceeds the strike price of the warrants. See Note 11, Debt, in the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements included in this Annual Report for further discussion. Interest Rate Risk Our exposure to interest rate risk at December 31, 2023 is related to our investment portfolio which consists of municipal bonds, corporate debt securities, commercial paper, asset-backed securities, and securities of government, federal agency, and other sovereign obligations of high quality financial institutions. Due to the short-term nature of these investments, we have assessed that there is no material exposure to interest rate risk arising from our investments. Fixed rate investments and borrowings may have their fair market value adversely impacted from changes in interest rates. Based upon our overall interest rate exposure as of December 31, 2023, a change of 10 percent in interest rates, assuming the amount of our investment portfolio and overall economic environment remains constant, would not have a material effect on interest income. The primary objective of our investment activities is to preserve the principal while at the same time maximizing yields without significantly increasing the risk. To achieve this objective, we maintain our portfolio of cash equivalents and investments in instruments that meet high credit quality standards, as specified in our investment policy. None of our investments are held for trading purposes. Our policy also limits the amount of credit exposure to any one issue, issuer and type of instrument. As of December 31, 2023, we only held investments in securities classified as cash equivalents and marketable equity securities. During the periods presented, we did not hold any investments that were in a significant unrealized loss position and no impairment charges were recorded. Realized gains and losses and interest income related to cash equivalents were immaterial during all periods presented. Foreign Exchange Risk We operate in countries outside of the U.S. and, therefore, we are exposed to foreign currency risk. Most of our direct sales outside of the U.S. are invoiced in local currencies. However, as our business in markets outside of the U.S. continues to increase, our exposure to foreign currency exchange risk related to our foreign operations will continue to grow. Fluctuations in the rate of exchange between the U.S. dollar and foreign currencies, primarily the Australian dollar, the Brazilian real, the British pound sterling, the Colombian peso, the euro, the Japanese yen, and the Singapore dollar, has had and could continue to have an adverse effect on our financial results, including our net sales, net sales growth rates, gross margins, income and losses as well as assets and liabilities. In particular, as a result of NuVasive’s acquisition of Simplify Medical, we have additional exposure to fluctuations in the Australian dollar. We established intercompany receivables and payables in Australian dollars as a result of the acquisition of Simplify Medical. We also have future contingent consideration liabilities denominated in U.S. dollars, in connection with the acquisition of Simplify Medical, which are the financial obligation of our subsidiary, NuVasive (AUST/NZ) Pty Limited, an Australian dollar denominated company. In addition, loss of financial stability within these markets could lead to delays in reimbursement or inability to remit payment due to currency controls. Specifically, we have operations in Puerto Rico, Brazil, and Argentina that have financial instability or currency controls. We translate the financial statements of our foreign subsidiaries with functional currencies other than the U.S. dollar into the U.S. dollar for consolidation using end-of-period exchange rates for assets and liabilities and average exchange rates during each reporting period for results of operations. Net gains or losses resulting from the translation of foreign financial statements and the effect of exchange rate changes on intercompany receivables and payables of a long-term investment nature are recorded as a separate component of stockholders’ equity. These adjustments will affect net income only upon sale or liquidation of the underlying investment in foreign subsidiaries. Exchange rate fluctuations resulting from the translation of all other intercompany balances between domestic 59 Table of Contents entities and our foreign subsidiaries are recorded as foreign currency transaction gains or losses and are included in other expense, net in the Consolidated Statements of Operations. For certain intercompany balances, we may enter into foreign currency forward contracts to partially offset the impact from fluctuation of the foreign currency rates. The notional amount of the outstanding foreign currency forward contracts was $10.0 million as of December 31, 2023, which were settled in January 2024. During the year ended December 31, 2023, a loss of $0.1 million was recognized in other expense, net due to the change in the fair value of the derivative instruments, and the fair value of the hedge contracts we held was de minimis on our Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2023. The derivative instruments are recorded in other current assets or other current liabilities in the Consolidated Balance Sheets commensurate with the nature of the instrument at period end. The notional principal amounts provide one measure of the transaction volume outstanding as of period end, but do not represent the amount of our exposure to market loss. The estimates of fair value are based on applicable and commonly used pricing models using prevailing financial market information. The amounts ultimately realized upon settlement of these financial instruments, together with the gains and losses on the underlying exposures, will depend on actual market conditions during the remaining life of the instruments. The financial exposures by exchange rate fluctuations are monitored and managed by us as an integral part of our overall risk management program, which recognizes the unpredictability of financial markets and seeks to reduce potentially adverse effects on our results. 60 Table of Contents Item 8. Financial Statements and Supplementary Data GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm ( Deloitte & Touche LLP, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania, PCAOB ID No. 34) Consolidated Balance Sheets Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income Consolidated Statements of Equity Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 62 65 66 67 68 69 61 Table of Contents REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM To the shareholders and the Board of Directors of Globus Medical, Inc. Opinion on the Financial Statements We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Globus Medical, Inc. and subsidiaries (the "Company") as of December 31, 2023 and 2022, the related consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income, equity, and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2023, and the related notes and the schedule listed in the Index at Item 15(a)(2) (collectively referred to as the "financial statements"). In our opinion, the financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as of December 31, 2023 and 2022, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2023, in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the Company's internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2023, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated February 20, 2024, expressed an unqualified opinion on the Company's internal control over financial reporting. Basis for Opinion These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company's financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB. We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion. Critical Audit Matter The critical audit matters communicated below are matters arising from the current-period audit of the financial statements that were communicated or required to be communicated to the audit committee and that (1) relate to accounts or disclosures that are material to the financial statements and (2) involved our especially challenging, subjective, or complex judgments. The communication of critical audit matters does not alter in any way our opinion on the financial statements, taken as a whole, and we are not, by communicating the critical audit matters below, providing separate opinions on the critical audit matters or on the accounts or disclosures to which they relate. Inventories Valuation – Refer to Notes 2 and 7 to the financial statements Critical Audit Matter Description Inventories are recorded at the lower of cost or net realizable value. Management periodically evaluates the carrying value of inventories in relation to the forecasts of product demand, which takes into consideration the estimated life cycle of product releases. When quantities on hand exceed sales forecasts, a write-down is recorded for such excess inventories. Changes in assumptions of product demand could have a significant impact on the amount of write- down recorded. Given the inherent uncertainty in forecasting product demand, including the impact of product releases, auditing the reasonableness of management’s estimates and assumptions required a high degree of auditor judgment and an increased extent of effort. How the Critical Audit Matter Was Addressed in the Audit Our procedures related to management’s forecasts of product demand used to record a write-down for excess and obsolete inventories included the following, among others: 62 Table of Contents • We tested the effectiveness of controls over management’s inventory valuation model, including those over management’s development and approval of product demand forecasts. • We evaluated management’s ability to accurately forecast product demand by comparing actual results to management’s historical estimates. • We selected a sample of products and verified that the product demand forecasts were supported by historical sales data and other current information. • We performed corroborative inquiries with the personnel responsible for product development and sales forecasting to evaluate the reasonableness of the product demand forecasts. • We tested the mathematical accuracy of management’s calculations. Business Combinations – NuVasive Merger — Refer to Notes 1 and 3 to the financial statements Critical Audit Matter Description On September 1, 2023, the Company completed its merger with NuVasive, Inc. with NuVasive, Inc. surviving as a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, for total consideration of approximately $2.604 billion. Management accounted for the acquisition as a business combination using the acquisition method of accounting. The most significant items recorded included intangible assets of $899.0 million, inventories of $558.0 million, senior convertible notes of $409.5 million, and resulting goodwill of $1,234 million. Management utilized third-party valuation specialists to assist in the determination of the fair value of the assets acquired. The methods used to estimate the fair value involved significant assumption. The principal considerations for our determination that performing procedures relating to the accounting for this transition is a critical audit matter are (i) the significant judgment by management when developing the fair value estimates of the assets acquired; (ii) a high degree of auditor judgment, subjectivity, and effort in performing procedures and evaluating audit evidence related to management's fair value estimates of the assets acquired; and (iii) the audit effort involved the use of professionals with specialized skill and knowledge. How the Critical Audit Matter Was Addressed in the Audit Our audit procedures related to the NuVasive Merger included the following, among others: • We read the agreement and plan of merger. • We tested the effectiveness of controls relating to the purchase price allocation, including controls over management’s valuation of the assets acquired and liabilities acquired. • We evaluated the appropriateness of the valuation methods and completeness and accuracy of significant inputs for fair value measurements used to develop estimates of assets and liabilities acquired. • We tested the accuracy of the purchase price allocation and goodwill recorded. • We utilized professionals with specialized skill and knowledge to assist in evaluating the appropriateness of the valuation methods and the reasonableness of the significant inputs for fair value measurements. /s/ DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP Philadelphia, Pennsylvania February 20, 2024 We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2017. 63 Table of Contents REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM To the shareholders and the Board of Directors of Globus Medical, Inc. Opinion on Internal Control over Financial Reporting We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of Globus Medical, Inc. and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of December 31, 2023, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2023, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by COSO. We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB), the consolidated financial statements as of and for the year ended December 31, 2023, of the Company and our report dated February 20, 2024, expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements. As described in Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting, management excluded from its assessment the internal control over financial reporting at NuVasive, Inc., which was acquired on September 1, 2023 and whose financial statements constitute 26% of total assets and 26% of revenues of the consolidated financial statement amounts as of and for the year ended December 31, 2023. Accordingly, our audit did not include the internal control over financial reporting at NuVasive, Inc. Basis for Opinion The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audit. We are a public accounting firm registered with the PCAOB and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB. We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion. Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements. Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. /s/ DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP Philadelphia, Pennsylvania February 20, 2024 64 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS (In thousands, except share and per share values) ASSETS Current assets: Cash and cash equivalents Short-term marketable securities Accounts receivable, net of allowances of $8,934 and $4,724, respectively Inventories Prepaid expenses and other current assets Income taxes receivable Total current assets Property and equipment, net of accumulated depreciation of $425,695 and $343,036, respectively Operating lease right of use assets Long-term marketable securities Intangible assets, net Goodwill Other assets Deferred income taxes Total assets LIABILITIES AND EQUITY Current liabilities: Accounts payable Accrued expenses Operating lease liabilities Income taxes payable Business acquisition liabilities Deferred revenue Total current liabilities Business acquisition liabilities, net of current portion Operating lease liabilities Senior convertible notes Deferred income taxes and other tax liabilities Other liabilities Total liabilities Commitments and contingencies (Note 16) December 31, 2023 December 31, 2022 $ $ 467,292 $ 50,497 503,235 848,135 44,580 1,635 1,915,374 586,932 59,931 75,428 924,603 1,434,540 78,590 10,685 5,086,083 $ $ 56,671 $ 240,460 11,967 3,845 61,035 18,369 392,347 78,323 91,037 417,400 84,421 24,596 1,088,124 150,466 295,592 213,247 298,981 20,997 4,061 983,344 243,729 5,988 495,852 63,574 197,471 37,323 48,845 2,076,126 36,101 92,169 2,536 990 13,308 14,100 159,204 54,950 3,475 — 1,779 10,345 229,753 Equity: Class A common stock; $0.001 par value. Authorized 500,000,000 shares; issued and outstanding 113,905,565 and 77,762,282 shares at December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, respectively Class B common stock; $0.001 par value. Authorized 275,000,000 shares; issued and outstanding 22,430,097 and 22,430,097 shares at December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, respectively Additional paid-in capital Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss) Retained earnings Total equity Total liabilities and equity $ 114 78 22 2,870,749 (10,192) 1,137,266 3,997,959 5,086,083 $ 22 630,952 (24,630) 1,239,951 1,846,373 2,076,126 See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements. 65 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS AND COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (In thousands, except per share amounts) Net sales Cost of sales Gross profit Operating expenses: Research and development Selling, general and administrative Provision for litigation, net Amortization of intangibles Acquisition-related costs Total operating expenses Operating income/(loss) Other income/(expense), net Interest income/(expense), net Foreign currency transaction gain/(loss) Other income/(expense) Total other income/(expense), net Income/(loss) before income taxes Income tax provision $ Year Ended December 31, 2022 1,022,843 $ 2023 1,568,476 $ 548,174 1,020,302 263,725 759,118 124,010 643,410 434 51,032 68,274 887,160 73,015 432,117 2,341 17,735 5,959 531,167 2021 958,102 239,223 718,879 97,346 408,149 5,921 18,526 16,984 546,926 133,142 227,951 171,953 20,130 14,259 (2,138) 32,251 165,393 42,520 14,233 (1,020) 1,855 15,068 9,297 (1,423) 580 8,454 243,019 52,850 180,407 31,216 Net income/(loss) $ 122,873 $ 190,169 $ 149,191 Other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax: Unrealized gain/(loss) on marketable securities Foreign currency translation gain/(loss) Total other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax Comprehensive income/(loss) Earnings per share: Basic Diluted Weighted average shares outstanding: Basic Diluted $ $ $ 13,231 1,207 14,438 137,311 $ (14,040) (3,818) (17,858) 172,311 $ (6,054) (4,673) (10,727) 138,464 1.09 $ 1.07 $ 1.89 $ 1.85 $ 1.48 1.44 113,087 114,630 100,469 102,643 100,734 103,623 See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements. 66 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF EQUITY (In thousands) Balance at December 31, 2022 Stock-based compensation Grant of contingent restricted stock units Exercise of stock options Issuance of Class A common stock under employee and director equity option plans, net Issuance of equity for NuVasive Merger Comprehensive income/(loss) Repurchase and retirement of common stock Balance at December 31, 2023 77,762 $ — — 387 273 39,813 — 78 — — 0 0 40 — Class A Common Stock $ Shares Class B Common Stock Shares $ Additional paid-in capital 630,952 $ 52,773 1,925 12,396 Accumulated other comprehensive Retained income/(loss) earnings Total (24,630) $ 1,239,951 $ 1,846,373 52,773 1,925 12,396 — — — — — — 22,430 $ 22 $ — — — — — — — — — — — — (11,409) 2,184,112 — — — 14,438 — — 122,873 (11,409) 2,184,152 137,311 (4,329) 113,906 $ (4) 114 — — — 22,430 $ 22 $ 2,870,749 $ — (225,562) (225,558) (10,192) $ 1,137,266 $ 3,997,959 See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements. (In thousands) Balance at December 31, 2021 Stock-based compensation Grant of contingent restricted stock units Exercise of stock options Comprehensive income/(loss) Repurchase and retirement of common stock Balance at December 31, 2022 Class A Common Stock Shares 79,114 $ — $ 79 — — 999 — (2,351) 77,762 $ — 1 — (2) 78 Accumulated other Class B Common Stock Shares 22,430 $ — Additional paid-in capital $ 22 $ 553,787 $ 33,466 — comprehensive Retained income/(loss) earnings Total (6,772) $ 1,194,272 $ 1,741,388 33,466 — — — — — — — — 1,985 41,714 — — — (17,858) — — 190,169 1,985 41,715 172,311 — 22,430 $ — — 22 $ 630,952 $ — (144,493) (144,491) (24,630) $ 1,239,951 $ 1,846,373 See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements. Class A Common Stock (In thousands) Balance at December 31, 2020 Stock-based compensation Grant of contingent restricted stock units Exercise of stock options Comprehensive income/(loss) Balance at December 31, 2021 Shares 77,284 $ — — 1,830 — 79,114 $ $ 77 — — 2 — 79 Class B Common Stock Shares 22,430 $ — — — — 22,430 $ Additional paid-in capital $ 22 $ 457,161 $ 31,254 — 1,878 — 63,494 — — — 22 $ 553,787 $ Accumulated other comprehensive Retained income/(loss) earnings Total 3,955 $ 1,045,082 $ 1,506,297 31,254 — — 1,878 — — 63,496 — — 138,464 149,191 (10,727) (6,772) $ 1,194,272 $ 1,741,388 See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements. 67 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS (In thousands) Cash flows from operating activities: Net income Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities: Acquired in-process research and development Depreciation and amortization Amortization of premiums on marketable securities Provision for excess and obsolete inventory Amortization of inventory fair value step up Amortization of 2025 Note fair value step up Stock-based compensation expense Allowance for doubtful accounts Change in fair value of business acquisition liabilities Change in deferred income taxes (Gain)/loss on disposal of assets, net Payment of business acquisition related liabilities Net (gain)/loss from foreign currency adjustment (Increase) decrease in: Accounts receivable Inventories Prepaid expenses and other assets Increase (decrease) in: Accounts payable Accrued expenses and other liabilities Income taxes payable/receivable Net cash provided by/(used in) operating activities Cash flows from investing activities: Purchases of marketable securities Maturities of marketable securities Sales of marketable securities Purchases of property and equipment Acquisition of businesses, net of cash acquired and purchases of intangible and other assets Net cash provided by/(used in) investing activities Cash flows from financing activities: Payment of business acquisition-related liabilities Net proceeds from exercise of stock options Payments related to tax withholdings for share-based compensation Repurchase of common stock Net cash provided by/(used in) financing activities Effect of foreign exchange rates on cash Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period Cash and cash equivalents at end of period Supplemental disclosures of cash flow information: Income taxes paid, net Non-cash investing and financing activities: Equity issued in conjunction with the NuVasive Merger Accrued purchases of property and equipment Year Ended December 31, 2022 2023 2021 $ 122,873 $ 190,169 $ 149,191 — 144,733 793 10,959 71,656 8,176 52,742 3,658 17,434 (57,789) 1,541 (3,005) (13,674) (49,914) (70,328) 1,148 (14,223) 17,127 (408) 243,499 (100,643) 240,190 537,723 (78,274) (296,028) 302,968 (8,039) 12,397 (10,617) (225,562) (231,821) 2,180 316,826 150,466 467,292 $ 150 68,252 5,389 6,400 — — 32,810 (1) 5,132 (22,223) 299 (2,647) — (50,843) (61,745) (10,292) 14,418 6,087 (2,887) 178,468 (419,534) 312,221 102,433 (74,047) (31,435) (110,362) (7,185) 41,716 — (144,493) (109,962) (747) (42,603) 193,069 150,466 $ 34,312 69,867 2,781 6,143 — — 30,586 1,200 16,807 (17,615) 464 (210) — (25,895) (11,971) (6,178) 3,684 17,896 5,212 276,274 (622,359) 227,908 109,898 (56,898) (34,488) (375,939) (9,349) 63,496 — — 54,147 (810) (46,328) 239,397 193,069 100,593 $ 77,823 $ 45,027 2,153,860 $ 7,100 $ — 7,423 $ — 4,551 $ $ $ $ See accompanying notes to consolidated financial statements. 68 Table of Contents NOTE 1. BACKGROUND (a) The Company GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS Globus Medical, Inc., together with its majority-owned or controlled subsidiaries, is a medical device company that develops and commercializes healthcare solutions with a mission to improve the quality of life of patients with musculoskeletal disorders. We are primarily focused on implants that promote healing in patients with musculoskeletal disorders, including the use of a robotic guidance and navigation system and products to treat patients who have experienced orthopedic traumas. We are an engineering-driven company with a history of rapidly developing and commercializing advanced products and procedures to assist surgeons in effectively treating their patients and to address new treatment options. With numerous products launched since the founding of the Company, including 10 products launched in 2023, we offer a comprehensive portfolio of innovative and differentiated technologies that address a variety of musculoskeletal pathologies, anatomies, and surgical approaches. We are headquartered in Audubon, Pennsylvania, and market and sell our products through our exclusive sales force in the United States, as well as within North, Central & South America, Europe, Asia, Africa and Australia. The sales force consists of direct sales representatives and distributor sales representatives employed by exclusive independent distributors. The terms the “Company,” “Globus,” “we,” “us” and “our” refer to Globus Medical, Inc. and, where applicable, our consolidated subsidiaries. (b) NuVasive Merger On September 1, 2023, pursuant to that certain merger agreement (the “Merger Agreement”) with NuVasive, Inc. (“NuVasive”) and Zebra Merger Sub, Inc. (“Merger Sub”), Merger Sub, a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, merged with and into NuVasive, with NuVasive surviving as a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company (the “Merger”). Under the Merger Agreement, each share of common stock, par value $0.001 per share, of NuVasive issued and outstanding immediately prior to the effective time of the Merger (other than certain excluded shares as described in the Merger Agreement) was cancelled and converted into the right to receive 0.75 fully paid and non-assessable shares of Class A common stock of Globus, $0.001 par value per share, and the right to receive cash in lieu of fractional shares. Globus was deemed to be the accounting acquirer of NuVasive for accounting purposes under U.S. generally accepted accounting principles (“U.S. GAAP”). Accordingly, prior periods within these consolidated financial statements may not be comparable. NOTE 2. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (a) Basis of Presentation The accompanying consolidated financial statements have been prepared in conformity with U.S. GAAP. (b) Prior Period Reclassifications Certain prior period amounts have been reclassified to conform to the current period presentation. “Operating lease right of use assets” were reclassified out of “Other assets”, and “Operating lease liabilities” were reclassified out of “Accrued expenses” and “Other liabilities”, respectively, depending on the short-term and long-term nature, on our consolidated balance sheets. (c) Principles of Consolidation The accompanying consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Globus and its majority-owned or controlled subsidiaries. All intercompany balances and transactions are eliminated in consolidation. Variable Interest Entities We provide intraoperative neuromonitoring (“IONM”) services through various majority owned or controlled subsidiaries, which collectively conduct business as NuVasive Clinical Services. In providing IONM services to surgeons and healthcare facilities across the U.S., the Company maintains contractual relationships with several physician practices (“PCs”). In accordance with authoritative guidance, the Company has determined that the PCs are variable interest entities and therefore, the accompanying consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the PCs from the date of acquisition. During the periods presented, the results of the PCs were immaterial to the Company’s 69 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) financial statements. The creditors of the PCs have claims only to the assets of the PCs, which are not material, and the assets of the PCs are not available to the Company. (d) Use of Estimates The preparation of consolidated financial statements in conformity with U.S. GAAP requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosures of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the consolidated financial statements, and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. We base our estimates, in part, on historical experience that management believes to be reasonable under the circumstances. Actual results could differ from those estimates. Estimates and assumptions are periodically reviewed and the effects of revisions are reflected in the consolidated financial statements in the period they are determined to be necessary. Significant areas that require estimates include revenue recognition, intangible assets, business acquisition liabilities, allowance for doubtful accounts, stock-based compensation, reserves for excess and obsolete inventory, fair value measurements, useful lives of assets, the outcome of litigation, recoverability of intangible assets and income taxes. We are subject to risks and uncertainties due to changes in the healthcare environment, regulatory oversight, competition, and legislation that may cause actual results to differ from estimated results. (e) Revenue Recognition In accordance with Accounting Standards Codification 606 Revenue from Contracts with Customers, (“ASC 606”), the Company recognizes revenue upon the transfer of goods or services to a customer at an amount that reflects the expected consideration to be received in exchange for those goods or services. The principles in ASC 606 are applied using the following five steps: (i) identify the contract with a customer; (ii) identify the performance obligation(s) in the contract; (iii) determine the transaction price; (iv) allocate the transaction price to the performance obligation(s) in the contract; and (v) recognize revenue when (or as) the Company satisfies its performance obligation(s). Revenue is recognized upon transfer of control of promised products or services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration we expect to receive in exchange for those products or services. Sales and other taxes we collect concurrent with revenue-producing activities are excluded from revenue. For purposes of disclosure, we disaggregate our revenue into two categories, Musculoskeletal Solutions and Enabling Technologies. Our Musculoskeletal Solutions products consist primarily of the implantable devices, disposables, unique instruments, and neuromonitoring services, used in an expansive range of spine, orthopedic trauma, hip, knee and extremity procedures. The majority of our Musculoskeletal Solutions contracts have a single performance obligation and revenue is recognized at a point in time. For our IONM services, revenue is recognized in the period the service is performed, which can be either point in time or over time, depending how the performance obligation is defined for the amount of consideration expected to be received. Our policy is to classify shipping and handling costs billed to customers as sales and the related expenses as cost of sales. Our Enabling Technologies products are advanced hardware and software systems, and related technologies, that are designed to enhance a surgeon’s capabilities and streamline surgical procedures by making them less invasive, more accurate, and more reproducible to improve patient care. The majority of our Enabling Technologies product contracts contain multiple performance obligations, including maintenance and support, and revenue is recognized as we fulfill each performance obligation, generally at the point in time in which the obligation is fulfilled. When contracts have multiple performance obligations, we allocate the contract’s transaction price to each performance obligation using our best estimate of the standalone selling price of each distinct good or service in the contract. Nature of Products and Services A significant portion of our Musculoskeletal Solutions product revenue is generated from consigned inventory maintained at hospitals or with sales representatives. Revenue from the sale of consigned musculoskeletal products is recognized when we transfer control, which occurs at the time the product is used or implanted. For all other Musculoskeletal Solutions product transactions, we recognize revenue when we transfer control, which is generally when we transfer the title to the goods, provided there are no remaining performance obligations that can affect the customer’s final acceptance of the sale. For Musculoskeletal Solutions service transactions, we recognize revenue in the period the service is performed for the amount of consideration expected to be received. In certain cases, we offer the ability for customers to lease surgical instrumentation primarily on a non-sales type basis. The majority of Enabling Technologies product contracts contain multiple performance obligations, including maintenance and support, and revenue is recognized as we fulfill each performance obligation. When contracts have multiple performance obligations, we allocate the contract’s transaction price to each performance obligation using an observable price to determine the standalone selling price of each distinct good or service in the contract. Revenue for the performance obligations recognized at a point of time is recognized when we transfer control to the customer, which is generally at the point of shipment, but can also be at either delivery or installation, depending on the terms of the arrangement. 70 Table of Contents Contract Balances GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Timing of revenue recognition may differ from the timing of invoicing to customers. We record a receivable when revenue is recognized prior to invoicing, or deferred revenue when revenue is recognized subsequent to invoicing. Deferred revenue is comprised mainly of unearned revenue related to the sales of certain Enabling Technologies products, which includes maintenance and support services. Maintenance and support services are generally invoiced annually, at the beginning of each contract period, and revenue is recognized ratably over the maintenance period. For the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021, there was an immaterial amount of revenue recognized from previously deferred revenue. (f) Concentrations of Credit Risk Financial instruments, which potentially subject us to concentrations of credit risk, are primarily marketable securities and accounts receivable. Concentrations of credit risk with respect to accounts receivable are limited due to the large number of entities comprising our customer base. We perform ongoing credit evaluations of our customers and generally do not require collateral. There was no customer that accounted for 10% or more of sales for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021, respectively. (g) Cash and Cash Equivalents The Company considers all short-term, highly liquid investments with original maturities of 90 days or less at acquisition date to be cash equivalents. Cash equivalents, which consist of money market accounts, commercial paper and corporate debt securities are stated at fair value. (h) Marketable Securities Our marketable securities include municipal bonds, corporate debt securities, commercial paper, asset-backed securities, and securities of government, federal agency, and other sovereign obligations, and are classified as available-for-sale as of December 31, 2023 and 2022. Short-term and long-term marketable securities are recorded at fair value on our consolidated balance sheets. Any change in fair value for available-for-sale securities, that do not result in recognition or reversal of an allowance for credit loss or write down, is recorded, net of taxes, as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income or loss on our consolidated balance sheets. Premiums and discounts are recognized over the life of the related security as an adjustment to yield using the straight-line method. Realized gains or losses from the sale of marketable securities are determined on a specific identification basis. Realized gains and losses, interest income and the amortization/accretion of premiums/discounts are included as a component of other income/(expense), net, on our consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income. Interest receivable is recorded as a component of prepaid expenses and other current assets on our consolidated balance sheets. We invest in securities that meet or exceed standards as defined in our investment policy. Our policy also limits the amount of credit exposure to any one issue, issuer or type of security. We review declines in the fair value of our securities to determine whether they are resulting from expected credit losses or other factors. If the assessment indicates a credit loss exists, we recognize any measured impairment as an allowance for credit loss in our consolidated statements of operations. Any other impairments not recorded through allowance for credit losses is recognized in our other comprehensive income. (i) Fair Value Measurements Fair value is defined as the price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset or the liability in an orderly transaction between market participants on the measurement date. Additionally, a fair value hierarchy was established that prioritizes the inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value. The hierarchy gives the highest priority to unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs. The level within the fair value hierarchy is based on the lowest level of any input that is significant to the fair value measurement. Our assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis are classified and disclosed in one of the following three categories: Level 1—quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets and liabilities; Level 2—observable inputs other than quoted prices in active markets for identical assets and liabilities; and Level 3—unobservable inputs in which there is little or no market data available, which require the reporting entity to use significant unobservable inputs or valuation techniques. 71 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Contingent consideration represents contingent milestone, performance and revenue-sharing payment obligations related to acquisitions and is measured at fair value, based on significant inputs that are not observable in the market, which represents a Level 3 measurement within the fair value hierarchy. The valuation of contingent consideration uses assumptions we believe would be made by a market participant. We assess these assumptions on an ongoing basis as additional data impacting the assumptions is obtained. The fair value of contingent consideration is recorded in business acquisition liabilities on our consolidated balance sheets, and changes in the fair value of contingent consideration is recognized in acquisition-related costs in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income. The fair value of contingent restricted stock unit grants (“RSUs”) are recorded as additional paid-in capital in the consolidated balance sheet on the day of the grant due to the remote likelihood of forfeiture. The purchase price of business acquisitions is primarily allocated to the tangible and identifiable intangible assets acquired and liabilities assumed based on their estimated fair values on the acquisition date, with the excess recorded as goodwill. We utilize Level 3 inputs in the determination of the initial fair value. (j) Inventories Inventories are stated at the lower of cost or net realizable value. Cost is determined on a first-in, first-out basis. The majority of our inventory is finished goods and we utilize both in-house manufacturing and third-party suppliers to produce our products. We periodically evaluate the carrying value of our inventories in relation to estimated forecasts of product demand, which takes into consideration the life cycle of product releases. When quantities on hand exceed estimated sales forecasts, we record a write-down for such excess inventories. Once inventory has been written down, it creates a new cost basis for inventory that is not subsequently written up. (k) Property and Equipment Property and equipment is recorded at cost less accumulated depreciation. Additions or improvements are capitalized, while repairs and maintenance are expensed as incurred. Depreciation is recognized using the straight-line method over the related useful lives of the assets. When assets are sold or otherwise disposed of, the related property, equipment, and accumulated depreciation amounts are relieved from the accounts, and any gain or loss is recorded in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income. (l) Goodwill and Intangible Assets Goodwill represents the excess of purchase price over the fair values of the identifiable assets acquired less the liabilities assumed in the acquisition of a business. Goodwill is tested for impairment at least annually or whenever events or circumstances indicate that a carrying amount may be impaired. We perform our goodwill impairment analysis at the reporting unit level. We perform our annual impairment analysis by either comparing a reporting unit’s estimated fair value to its carrying amount or doing a qualitative assessment of a reporting unit’s fair value from the last quantitative assessment to determine if there is potential impairment. We may do a qualitative assessment when the results of the previous quantitative test indicated the reporting unit’s estimated fair value was significantly in excess of the carrying value of its net assets and we do not believe there have been significant changes in the reporting unit’s operations that would significantly decrease its estimated fair value or significantly increase its net assets. If a quantitative assessment is performed, the evaluation includes management estimates of discounted cash flow projections based on internal future projections and/or use of a market approach by looking at market values of comparable companies. We perform our annual impairment test of goodwill in the fourth quarter of each year. Intangible assets consist of purchased in-process research and development (“IPR&D”), developed technology, supplier network, patents, customer relationships, re-acquired rights, and non-compete agreements. Intangible assets with finite useful lives are amortized over the period of estimated benefit using the straight-line method and estimated useful lives ranging from one to twenty-one years. Intangible assets with finite useful lives are tested whenever events or circumstances indicate that a carrying amount of an asset (asset group) more likely than not is not recoverable. If an impairment is indicated, we measure the amount of the impairment loss as the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds the fair value of the asset. Fair value is generally determined using a discounted future cash flow analysis. IPR&D has an indefinite life and is not amortized until completion of the project at which time the IPR&D becomes an amortizable asset. Intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are tested for impairment annually or whenever events or circumstances indicate that a carrying amount of an asset (asset group) may not be recoverable. If the related project is not completed in a timely manner, we may have an impairment related to the IPR&D, calculated as the excess of the asset’s carrying value over its fair value. During the twelve months ended December 31, 2023, there were no impairments in goodwill, finite-lived intangible assets, or IPR&D. 72 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (m) Impairment of Long-Lived Assets We periodically evaluate the recoverability of the carrying amount of long-lived assets, which include property and equipment, as well as whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of an asset group may not be fully recoverable. An impairment is assessed when the undiscounted future cash flows from the use and eventual disposition of an asset group are less than its carrying value. If an impairment is indicated, we measure the amount of the impairment loss as the amount by which the carrying amount exceeds the fair value of the asset group. Our fair value methodology is based on quoted market prices, if available. If quoted market prices are not available, an estimate of fair value is made based on prices of similar assets or other valuation techniques including present value techniques. During the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021, we did not record any impairment charges related to long-lived assets. (n) Cost of Sales Cost of sales consists primarily of costs from our manufacturing operations, costs of products purchased from third-party suppliers, reserves for excess and obsolete inventory, depreciation of surgical instruments and cases, royalties, shipping, inspection and related costs incurred in making our products available for sale or use. (o) Research and Development Research and development costs are expensed as incurred. Research and development costs include salaries, employee benefits, supplies, consulting services, clinical services and clinical trial costs, and facilities costs. Costs incurred in obtaining technology licenses and patents are charged immediately to research and development expense if the technology licensed has not reached technological feasibility and has no alternative future use. (p) Stock-Based Compensation The cost of employee and non-employee director awards is measured at the grant date fair value of the award and is recognized as expense over the requisite service period, which is generally the vesting period of the equity award. Expense for performance-based restricted stock units is recognized when the performance condition is deemed to be probable. Compensation expense for awards includes the impact of forfeiture in the period when they occur. We estimate the fair value of stock options utilizing the Black-Scholes option-pricing model. Inputs to the Black-Scholes model include our stock price, expected volatility, expected term, risk-free interest rate and expected dividends. Expected volatility is based on the historical volatility of the Company’s common stock over the most recent period commensurate with the estimated expected term of the Company’s stock options offering period which is derived from historical experience. The risk-free interest rate assumption is based on observed interest rates of U.S. Treasury securities appropriate for the expected terms of the stock options. The dividend yield assumption is based on the history and expectation of no dividend payouts. The respective fair values of restricted stock units and performance restricted stock units are estimated on the day of grant based on the closing price of the Company’s common stock. We assumed equity-classified awards for certain NuVasive RSUs, and performance restricted stock units (“PRSUs”), as part of the Merger. These RSUs and PRSUs are measured at the grant date based on the estimated fair value of the award. The fair value of equity instruments that are expected to vest is recognized and amortized over the requisite service period. The Company has granted awards with up to five year graded or cliff vesting terms (in each case, with service through the date of vesting being required). No exercise price or other monetary payment is required for receipt of the shares issued in settlement of the respective award; instead, consideration is furnished in the form of the participant’s service to the Company. The fair value of RSUs including PRSUs with pre-defined performance criteria is based on the stock price on the date of grant whereas the expense for PRSUs with pre-defined performance criteria is adjusted with the probability of achievement of such performance criteria at each period end. (q) Derivative Financial Instruments The Company recognizes all derivative instruments as assets or liabilities in its Consolidated Balance Sheets and measures these instruments at fair value by revaluing these assets and liabilities at the end of each reporting period. Gains and losses are recorded as a component of other expense, net in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income. The effects of these derivative instruments are immaterial to the Company’s financial statements. 73 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (r) Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) Other comprehensive income (loss) is defined as the change in equity during a period from transactions and other events and circumstances from non-owner sources. Other comprehensive income (loss) includes net of tax, unrealized gains or losses on the Company’s marketable debt securities and foreign currency translation adjustments. (s) Provision for Litigation We are involved in a number of proceedings, legal actions, and claims. Such matters are subject to many uncertainties, and the outcomes of these matters are not within our control and may not be known for prolonged periods of time. In some actions, the claimants seek damages, as well as other relief, including injunctions prohibiting us from engaging in certain activities, which, if granted, could require significant expenditures and/or result in lost revenues. We record a liability in the consolidated financial statements for these actions when a loss is considered probable and the amount can be reasonably estimated. If the reasonable estimate of a probable loss is a range, and no amount within the range is a better estimate than any other, the minimum amount of the range is accrued. If a loss is reasonably possible but not known or probable, and can be reasonably estimated, the estimated loss or range of loss is disclosed. In most cases, significant judgment is required to estimate the amount and timing of a loss to be recorded. We expense legal costs related to loss contingencies as incurred. (t) Acquisition-Related Costs Acquisition-related costs represents the change in fair value of business acquisition-related contingent consideration and specific costs related to the consummation of the acquisition process such as banker fees, legal fees and other acquisition-related professional fees. (u) Foreign Currency Translation The functional currency of our foreign subsidiaries is generally their local currency. Assets and liabilities of the foreign subsidiaries, and intercompany receivables and payables of a long-term investment nature, are translated at the period end currency exchange rate and revenues and expenses are translated at an average currency exchange rate for the period. The resulting foreign currency translation gains and losses are included as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income. Gains and losses arising from intercompany foreign transactions are included in other income, net on the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income. (v) Accounts Receivable and Related Valuation Accounts Accounts receivable in the accompanying consolidated balance sheets are presented net of allowances for expected credit losses. We maintain an allowance for expected credit losses resulting from the inability of its customers, including hospitals, ambulatory surgery centers, and distributors, to make required payments. The allowance for credit losses is calculated quarterly and is estimated on a region-by-region basis considering a number of factors including age of account balances, collection history, historical account write-offs, third-party credit reports, identified trends, current economic conditions, and supportable forecasted economic expectations. The allowance is adjusted on a specific identification basis for certain accounts as well as pooling of accounts with similar characteristics. An increase in the provision for credit losses may be required when the financial condition of our customers or their collection experience deteriorates. Our exposure to credit losses may also increase if its customers are adversely affected by changes in healthcare laws, coverage and reimbursement, macroeconomic pressures or uncertainty associated with local or global economic recessions, disruption associated with pandemics, or other customer-specific factors. (w) Income Taxes Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for the future tax consequences attributable to differences between the financial statement carrying amounts of existing assets and liabilities and their respective tax bases. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured using enacted tax rates expected to apply to taxable income in the year in which such items are expected to be recovered or settled. The effect on deferred tax assets and liabilities of a change in tax rates is recognized in the period that includes the enactment date. A valuation allowance is established to offset any deferred tax assets if, based upon available evidence, it is more likely than not that some or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. Significant judgment is required in determining income tax provisions and in evaluating tax positions. We will establish additional provisions for income taxes when, despite the belief that tax positions are fully supportable, there remain certain positions that do not meet the minimum probability threshold that a tax position is more likely than not to be sustained upon examination by the taxing authority. In the normal course of business, we and our subsidiaries are examined by various federal, state, and foreign tax authorities. We regularly assess the potential outcomes of these examinations and any future examinations for the current or prior years in determining the adequacy of the provision for income taxes. We periodically assess the likelihood and amount of potential adjustments and adjust the income tax provision, the current tax liability, and deferred taxes in the period in which the facts that give rise to a revision become known. 74 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (x) Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements In December 2023, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (the “FASB”), issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) No. 2023-09, Income Taxes (Topic 740), Improvements to Income Tax Disclosures, to enhance the transparency and decision usefulness of income tax disclosures. The enhancement will provide information to better assess how an entity’s operations and related tax risks and tax planning and operational opportunities affect its tax rate and prospects for future cash flows. Investors currently rely on the rate reconciliation table and other disclosures, including total income taxes paid, to evaluate income tax risks and opportunities. This update is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2024 and early adoption is permitted. The amendments should be applied prospectively with retrospective applications also permitted. The Company is currently evaluating the impact the standard will have on its consolidated financial statements and related disclosures. In November 2023, the FASB, issued ASU No. 2023-07, Segment Reporting (Topic 280), Improvements to Reportable Segment Disclosures, to improve reportable segment disclosure requirements. The amendment introduced new requirementd to disclose significant segment expenses regularly provided to the chief operating decision maker (“CODM”), extend certain annual disclosures to interim periods, clarify single reportable segment entities must apply ASC 280 in its entirety, permit more than one measure of segment profit or loss to be reported under certain conditions, and require disclosure of the title and position of the CODM. This update is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2023 and interim periods within fiscal years after December 15, 2024, early adoption is permitted. The amendments should be applied retrospectively. The Company is currently evaluating the impact the standard will have on its consolidated financial statements and related disclosures. In June 2022, the FASB issued ASU No. 2022-03, Fair Value Measurement (Topic 820), Fair Value Measurement of Equity Securities Subject to Contractual Sale Restrictions, which clarifies that a contractual restriction on the sale of an equity security is not considered part of the unit of account of the equity security and, therefore, is not considered in measuring fair value. The ASU introduces new disclosure requirements to provide investors with information about contractual restrictions, including the nature and remaining duration of such restrictions. This update is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2023, and interim periods within those fiscal years, with early adoption permitted. The amendments should be applied prospectively with any adjustments from the adoption of the amendments recognized in earnings and disclosed on the date of adoption. The Company is currently evaluating the impact the standard will have on its consolidated financial statements. (y) Recently Adopted Accounting Pronouncements In October 2021, the FASB issued ASU No. 2021-08, Business Combinations (Topic 805), Accounting for Contract Assets and Contract Liabilities from Contracts with Customers, which requires an entity (acquirer) to recognize and measure contract assets and liabilities acquired in a business combination in accordance with Accounting Standards Codification (“ASC”) Topic 606, Revenue from Contracts with Customers (“ASC 606”). This update is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2022, and interim periods within those fiscal years, with early adoption permitted. The amendments should be applied prospectively to business combinations occurring on or after the effective date of the amendments. The Company adopted ASU No. 2021-08 as of January 1, 2023. The adoption did not have a material impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements. On March 12, 2020, the FASB issued ASU No. 2020-04, Facilitation of the Effects of Reference Rate Reform on Financial Reporting, which provides optional expedients and exceptions for applying generally accepted accounting principles to contract modifications and hedging relationships, subject to meeting certain criteria, that reference LIBOR or another reference rate expected to be discontinued. The ASU is effective for all entities as of March 12, 2020, and will apply, as later extended by ASU No. 2022-06, Reference Rate Reform (Topic 848): Deferral of the Sunset Date of Topic 848, through December 31, 2024. To date, we have had no impacts on our investment portfolio or our credit agreement with Citizens Bank, N.A. related to reference rate reform. We will continue to evaluate the impact this guidance could have on our consolidated financial statements and related disclosures. 75 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) NOTE 3. ASSET ACQUISITIONS AND BUSINESS COMBINATIONS Asset Acquisitions During the fourth quarter of 2021, the Company acquired substantially all the assets of Capstone Surgical Technologies, LLC, which engages in the business of advanced drill and robotic surgery platforms. The Company determined the transaction was an asset acquisition, by an analysis of the screen test in accordance with ASU No. 2017-01 in which substantially all of the value was concentrated in a single identifiable asset or a group of similar identifiable assets. The purchase price consisted of $24.5 million of cash paid at closing, subject to net working capital and other post-closing adjustments, if applicable. The transaction also provides for additional consideration contingent upon the developed products obtaining approval from the FDA of up to $15.0 million, and additional consideration contingent upon the achievement of certain performance obligations of up to $10.0 million. Contingent consideration is not recorded in an asset acquisition until the milestone is met. Also during the fourth quarter of 2021, the Company acquired substantially all the assets of a company that engages in the development of technology for use in robotic surgery platforms which was not considered material to the consolidated financial statements during the periods presented. The Company determined the transaction was an asset acquisition, by an analysis of the screen test in accordance with ASU No. 2017-01 in which substantially all of the value was concentrated in a single identifiable asset or a group of similar identifiable assets. The purchase price consisted of $10.0 million of cash paid at closing and also provides for additional consideration contingent upon the achievement of certain performance obligations of $5.0 million. Contingent consideration is not recorded in an asset acquisition until the milestone is met. Business Combinations During the fourth quarter of 2022, the Company acquired the membership interests of Harvest Biologics LLC (the “Harvest Acquisition”), which engages in the business of selling systems that produce autologous biologics. The purchase price was a cash payment of $30 million, subject to post-closing adjustments, if applicable. The Company has included the financial results from the Harvest Acquisition in our consolidated financial statements from the acquisition date. At acquisition date, the preliminary fair value of the net assets acquired was $30.1 million. The purchase price consisted of approximately $30.0 million of cash paid at closing, plus $0.1 million of preliminary post-closing adjustments. The Company recorded identifiable net assets, based on their estimated fair values, for inventory of $3.0 million, goodwill of $14.2 million, customer relationships and other intangibles of $10.5 million with a weighted average useful life of 20 years, and developed technology of $2.4 million with a weighted average useful life of 8 years. The Company has finalized the purchase price allocation of the assets and liabilities acquired. During the second quarter of 2022, the Company completed one acquisition that was not considered material to the consolidated financial statements during the periods presented. This acquisition has been included in the consolidated financial statements from the date of acquisition. The purchase price consisted of approximately $0.2 million of cash paid at closing and $4.4 million of contingent consideration payments, resulting in goodwill of $4.6 million based on the estimated fair values. The contingent payments for this acquisition are based upon achieving various performance milestones over a period of 10 years and are payable in a combination of cash and RSUs. During 2021, the Company completed three acquisitions that were not considered material, individually or collectively, to the consolidated financial statements during the periods presented. Two acquisitions were completed in the third quarter, while the third acquisition was completed in the fourth quarter. These acquisitions have been included in the consolidated financial statements from the date of acquisition. The purchase price of the acquisition in the fourth quarter consisted of approximately $0.3 million of cash paid at closing and $13.0 million of contingent consideration payments, resulting in goodwill of $13.3 million based on the estimated fair values. The combined purchase price of the two acquisitions in the third quarter consisted of approximately $12.6 million of contingent consideration payments. The Company recorded other intangible assets of $1.6 million, with a weighted average useful life of 3.8 years, and goodwill of $11.0 million based on their estimated fair values. The contingent payments for all three acquisitions are based upon achieving various performance obligations over a period of 10 years and are payable in a combination of cash and RSUs. NuVasive Merger On September 1, 2023, pursuant to that certain Merger Agreement with NuVasive and Merger Sub, Merger Sub, a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company, merged with and into NuVasive, with NuVasive surviving as a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company. Under the Merger Agreement, each share of common stock, par value $0.001 per share, of NuVasive issued and outstanding immediately prior to the effective time of the Merger (other than certain excluded shares as described in the Merger Agreement) was cancelled and converted into the right to receive 0.75 fully paid and non-assessable shares of Class A common stock of Globus, $0.001 par value per share, and the right to receive cash in lieu of fractional shares. NuVasive has a comprehensive procedural portfolio including surgical access instruments, spinal implants, fixation systems, biologics, software for surgical planning, navigation and imaging solutions, magnetically adjustable implant systems for spine and orthopedics, and IONM technology and service offerings. 76 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) As part of the Merger, the Company assumed equity awards for certain NuVasive RSUs and NuVasive PRSUs in accordance with the terms of the Merger Agreement. Certain awards included a change in control provision (single trigger) which accelerated the vesting of the awards on the closing date of the Merger. These awards were considered as part of the total purchase price. The unvested awards will continue to vest in accordance with the terms of the original award agreement, except for certain PRSUs that were converted into RSUs. Once vested, the holders will receive shares of the Company’s Class A common stock. Of the total consideration for the assumed equity awards, $28.6 million was allocated to the purchase price and $42.3 million was deemed compensatory as it was attributable to post acquisition vesting. Of the $42.3 million of total compensation related to the assumed awards, $12.9 million was expensed on the acquisition date due to accelerated vesting of the awards, recognized as Merger-related costs, and $29.4 million relates to future services and will be expensed over the remaining service periods of the unvested awards on a straight-line basis. Of the $29.4 million related to future services, $4.9 million of expense was recognized for the year ended December 31, 2023. Concurrently with the Merger, the Company repaid the outstanding $420.8 million under NuVasive’s revolving senior credit facility in addition to assuming the 0.375% Senior Convertible Notes due 2025 (“2025 Notes”), the privately negotiated call options (“2025 Hedge”) and the privately negotiated warrants (“2025 Warrants”). The aggregate consideration in connection with the closing of the Merger was as follows: (In thousands) NuVasive shares outstanding as of September 1, 2023 NuVasive accelerated equity awards Globus exchange ratio Globus Class A Common Stock issued in exchange for NuVasive shares Globus closing share price Total Value Class A Common Stock 2025 Warrants Repayment of revolving credit facility Fair value of assumed equity awards Total purchase price 52,451 632 0.75 39,813 $54.10 2,153,860 579 420,762 28,635 2,603,836 $ $ We accounted for the Merger using the acquisition method of accounting, which requires the NuVasive assets and liabilities to be recorded on our balance sheet at fair value as of the acquisition date. We will complete a final determination of the fair value of certain assets and liabilities within the one- year measurement period from the date of the acquisition as required by FASB ASC Topic 805, “Business Combinations”. The preliminary fair value estimates for the assets acquired and liabilities assumed were based upon preliminary calculations, valuations, and assumptions that are subject to change as the Company obtains additional information during the measurement period. 77 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (In thousands) Current assets (excluding accounts receivable and inventories) Accounts receivable Inventories Property, plant, and equipment Operating lease ROU asset Intangible assets Other long-term assets Deferred income taxes Total Assets Current Liabilities Operating lease liabilities, including current portion Business acquisition liabilities, including current portion Senior convertible notes Deferred income taxes and other tax liabilities Other liabilities Total liabilities Fair value of acquired identifiable assets and liabilities Purchase price Less: Fair value of acquired identifiable assets and liabilities Goodwill Preliminary Purchase Price Allocation as of September 30, 2023 Measurement Period and Other Adjustments Purchase Price Allocation as of December 31, 2023 (as adjusted) $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ 158,112 249,591 570,300 361,118 90,457 1,222,000 25,973 4,837 2,682,388 185,175 109,110 66,873 409,500 194,553 37,496 1,002,707 1,679,681 2,603,836 (1,679,681) 924,155 38 (6,912) (12,266) 598 (32,174) (323,000) 13,111 977 (359,628) (1,718) (7,758) — — (16,035) (23,797) (49,308) (310,320) $ $ $ $ $ $ $ 158,150 242,679 558,034 361,716 58,283 899,000 39,084 5,814 2,322,760 183,457 101,352 66,873 409,500 178,518 13,699 953,399 1,369,362 2,603,836 (1,369,362) 1,234,475 The excess of the purchase price over the net tangible and intangible assets is recorded to Goodwill and primarily reflects the assembled workforce and expected synergies. The majority of goodwill is non-deductible for tax purposes. During the year ended December 31, 2023, total transaction costs incurred in connection with the Merger were $49.8 million. These transaction costs were recognized as acquisition-related costs in the consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income. Details of our valuation methodology and significant inputs for fair value measurements are included below. The fair value measurements for property, plant and equipment and intangible assets are based on significant inputs that are not observable in the market and, therefore, represent Level 3 measurements. The preliminary fair value of work-in-process and finished goods inventory utilizes a sales comparison approach which estimates the selling price of the inventory in completed condition less costs of disposal and a reasonable profit allowance for the selling effort. The preliminary fair value of property and equipment utilizes a combination of the cost approach, income approach, and sales comparison approach less amounts for capitalized research and development costs existing on NuVasive’s closing balance sheet. The preliminary fair value of the identifiable intangible assets was determined using variations of the income approach, namely the multi-period excess earnings and relief from royalty methodologies. The most significant assumptions applied in the development of the intangible asset fair values include: the amount and timing of future cash flows, the selection of discount and royalty rates, and the assessment of the asset’s economic life. The preliminary fair value of the operating lease ROU asset utilizes a market approach in determination of the measured asset. The preliminary fair value of the operating lease liability utilizes a discounted cost approach in determination of the measured liability. 78 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) The identifiable intangible assets acquired are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives. The following table summarizes the estimated fair value of NuVasive’s identifiable intangible assets acquired and their remaining amortization period (in years): (In thousands) Developed Technology Customer Relationships Fair Value as of December 31, 2023 $ 607,000 292,000 Useful Life 8 11 Preliminary fair value of the 2025 Notes was determined using the publicly traded price. NuVasive’s results have been included in the Company’s financial statements for the period subsequent to the date of the acquisition on September 1, 2023. NuVasive contributed revenues of $414.9 million, for the period from September 1, 2023 to December 31, 2023. Due to the continuing integration of NuVasive’s operations into the Company, it is impractical to determine NuVasive’s net income/loss during the period, which is included in the Company’s Net Income. Supplemental Unaudited Pro Forma Information The following are the supplemental consolidated financial results of Globus and NuVasive on an unaudited pro forma basis, as if the acquisitions had been consummated as of the beginning of fiscal year 2022. (In thousands) Pro forma net sales Pro forma net income Year Ended December 31, $ 2023 2,395,812 121,017 2022 $ 2,224,785 (27,281) The unaudited pro forma net income for the year ended December 31, 2023 was adjusted to exclude $111.4 million of acquisition-related costs incurred in 2023. The unaudited pro forma net income for the year ended December 31, 2022, was adjusted to include the aforementioned charges. NOTE 4. NET SALES The following table represents net sales by product category: (In thousands) Musculoskeletal Solutions Enabling Technologies Total net sales $ $ 2023 1,448,260 $ 120,216 1,568,476 $ Year Ended December 31, 2022 926,703 96,140 1,022,843 $ $ 2021 876,780 81,322 958,102 79 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) NOTE 5. MARKETABLE SECURITIES The composition of our short-term and long-term marketable securities is as follows: (In thousands) Short-term: Municipal bonds Corporate debt securities Government, federal agency, and other sovereign obligations Total short-term marketable securities Long-term: Municipal bonds Corporate debt securities Asset-backed securities Government, federal agency, and other sovereign obligations Total long-term marketable securities (In thousands) Short-term: Municipal bonds Corporate debt securities Commercial paper Asset-backed securities Government, federal agency, and other sovereign obligations Total short-term marketable securities Long-term: Municipal bonds Corporate debt securities Asset-backed securities Government, federal agency, and other sovereign obligations Total long-term marketable securities December 31, 2023 Amortized Cost Gross Unrealized Gains Gross Unrealized Losses Fair Value $ $ $ $ $ $ $ $ 11,210 38,416 2,004 51,630 7,180 21,707 17,499 30,363 76,749 $ $ $ $ — $ — — — $ — $ — — — — $ (224) (853) (56) (1,133) $ $ (109) (432) (338) (442) (1,321) $ $ Amortized Cost December 31, 2022 Gross Unrealized Gains Gross Unrealized Losses 83,279 $ 187,174 5,583 4,200 21,102 301,338 $ 61,986 $ 268,524 120,929 58,453 509,892 $ 9 $ 2 — — 1 12 $ 44 $ 72 217 18 351 $ (1,680) $ (3,438) (1) (181) (458) (5,758) $ (1,549) $ (8,947) (2,795) (1,100) (14,391) $ 10,986 37,563 1,948 50,497 7,071 21,275 17,161 29,921 75,428 Fair Value 81,608 183,738 5,582 4,019 20,645 295,592 60,481 259,649 118,351 57,371 495,852 The short-term marketable securities have effective maturity dates of less than one year and the long-term marketable securities have effective maturity dates ranging from one to three years as of December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively. NOTE 6. FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS The following table represents the fair value of assets and liabilities, as of December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively included the following: 80 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (In thousands) Assets: Cash equivalents Municipal bonds Corporate debt securities Asset-backed securities Government, federal agency, and other sovereign obligations 2025 Hedge Liabilities: Senior Convertible Notes due 2025 Bifurcated Conversion Option of the Senior Convertible Notes due 2025 Business acquisition liabilities $ Balance at December 31, 2023 Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 203,689 $ — $ 203,689 $ 18,057 58,838 17,161 31,869 687 — — — 2,928 — 417,363 687 139,358 417,363 — — 18,057 58,838 17,161 28,941 687 — 687 — — — — — — — — — 139,358 (In thousands) Assets: Cash equivalents Municipal bonds Corporate debt securities Commercial paper Asset-backed securities Government, federal agency, and other sovereign obligations Liabilities: Business acquisition liabilities Balance at December 31, 2022 Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 $ 17,655 $ 142,089 443,387 5,582 122,370 78,016 17,655 $ — — — — — — $ 142,089 443,387 5,582 122,370 78,016 — — — — — — 68,258 — — 68,258 Our marketable securities are classified as Level 2 within the fair value hierarchy, as we measure their fair value using quoted market prices for similar instruments and inputs such as actual trade data, benchmark yields, broker/dealer quotes and other similar data obtained from quoted market prices or independent pricing vendors. The bifurcated conversion option and 2025 Hedge are classified as Level 2 within the fair value hierarchy, based on implied equity volatility. The estimated fair value of the 2025 Notes, inclusive of the embedded conversion option, at December 31, 2023 was $418.0 million. The fair value was determined based on the quoted price of the 2025 Notes in an active market on the last trading day of the reporting period and has been classified as Level 1 within the fair value hierarchy. 81 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Fair value of the revenue-based business acquisition liabilities was determined using a discounted cash flow model and an option pricing methodology. The significant inputs of such models are not observable in the market, such as certain financial metric growth rates, volatility and discount rates, market price risk adjustment, projections associated with the applicable milestone, the interest rate, and the related probabilities and payment structure in the contingent consideration arrangement. The following are the significant unobservable inputs used in the two valuation techniques: Unobservable input Revenue risk premium Revenue volatility Discount rate Projected year of payment * The weighted average rates were calculated based on the relative fair value of each business acquisition liability. 2.0% 12.5% 5.9% 2024 Range - - - - 5.5% 15.8% 8.5% 2032 Weighted Average* 2.7% 13.9% 6.6% The change in the carrying value of the business acquisition liabilities during the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively included the following: (In thousands) Beginning balance Purchase price contingent consideration Contingent cash payments Contingent RSU grants Changes in fair value of business acquisition liabilities Contractual payable reclassification Ending balance Year Ended December 31, 2023 2022 $ $ 68,258 $ 66,873 (11,044) (1,925) 17,434 (238) 139,358 $ 70,525 4,414 (9,787) (1,986) 5,132 (40) 68,258 We translate the financial statements of our foreign subsidiaries with functional currencies other than the U.S. dollar into the U.S. dollar for consolidation using end-of-period exchange rates for assets and liabilities and average exchange rates during each reporting period for results of operations. Some of our reporting entities conduct a portion of their business in currencies other than the entity’s functional currency. These transactions give rise to receivables and payables that are denominated in currencies other than the entity’s functional currency. The value of these receivables and payables is subject to changes in currency exchange rates from the point at which the transactions are originated until the settlement in cash. Both realized and unrealized gains and losses in the value of these receivables and payables are included in the determination of net income or loss. Net currency exchange gains/(losses), which include gains and losses from derivative instruments, were $14.1 million and ($1.0) million for the year ended December 31, 2023 and December 31, 2022, respectively, and are included in other expense, net in the Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income. To manage foreign currency exposure risks, we may use derivatives for activities in entities that have short-term intercompany receivables and payables denominated in a currency other than the entity’s functional currency. The fair value is based on a quoted market price (Level 1). As of December 31, 2023, a notional principal amount of $10.0 million was outstanding to hedge currency risk relative to our foreign currency-denominated receivables and payables. Derivative instrument net losses on our forward exchange contracts were $0.1 million as of December 31, 2023 and are included in other expense, net in the Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income. The fair value of the forward exchange contract derivative instrument asset (liability) was di minimis as of December 31, 2023. The derivative instruments are recorded in other current assets or other current liabilities in the Consolidated Balance Sheets commensurate with the nature of the instrument at period end. NOTE 7. INVENTORIES Inventories as of December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively included the following: (In thousands) Raw materials Work in process Finished goods Total inventories December 31, 2023 103,349 $ 37,321 707,465 848,135 $ 2022 60,324 18,699 219,958 298,981 $ $ 82 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) As part of the NuVasive Merger, a step-up in the value of inventory of $202.6 million was recorded, which was composed of $3.0 million for work in process and $199.6 million for finished goods. The amortization of the inventory step-up recorded in product cost of sales was $71.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2023, respectively. As of December 31, 2023, the total remaining balance of inventory step-up was $131.1 million. During years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021, net adjustments to cost of sales related to excess and obsolete inventory were $10.9 million, $6.4 million, and $6.1 million, respectively. The net adjustments for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021 reflect a combination of additional expense for excess and obsolete related provisions ($18.1 million, $18.5 million, and $20.2 million, respectively) offset by sales and disposals ($7.2 million, $12.1 million, and $14.1 million, respectively) of inventory for which an excess and obsolete provision was previously recorded. NOTE 8. PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT Property and equipment as of December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively included the following: (In thousands) Land Buildings and improvements Equipment Instruments, modules, and cases Other property and equipment Less: accumulated depreciation and amortization Total Useful Life — 31.5 5-15 5 3-5 December 31, 2023 December 31, 2022 $ $ 9,748 $ 102,449 206,392 672,018 22,020 1,012,627 (425,695) 586,932 $ 8,277 51,510 148,803 360,078 18,097 586,765 (343,036) 243,729 Instruments are hand-held devices used by surgeons to install implants during surgery. Modules and cases are used to store and transport the instruments and implants. Depreciation expense related to property and equipment was as follows: (In thousands) Depreciation NOTE 9. GOODWILL AND INTANGIBLE ASSETS Year Ended December 31, 2022 2023 2021 $ 93,702 $ 50,517 $ 51,342 The change in the carrying amount of goodwill during the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively included the following: (In thousands) December 31, 2021 Additions and adjustments Foreign exchange December 31, 2022 Additions and adjustments Foreign exchange December 31, 2023 83 $ $ 179,708 18,799 (1,036) 197,471 1,235,890 1,179 1,434,540 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Intangible assets as of December 31, 2023 included the following: (In thousands) Supplier network Customer relationships & other intangibles Developed technology Patents Total intangible assets Intangible assets as of December 31, 2022 included the following: (In thousands) Supplier network Customer relationships & other intangibles Developed technology Patents Total intangible assets Weighted Average Amortization Period (in years) 10.0 10.6 8.0 16.1 Weighted Average Amortization Period (in years) 10.0 8.7 8.0 16.1 December 31, 2023 Gross Carrying Amount Accumulated Amortization $ $ 4,000 $ 353,849 695,226 9,266 1,062,341 $ (3,667) $ (54,871) (74,636) (4,564) (137,738) $ Intangible Assets, net 333 298,978 620,590 4,702 924,603 December 31, 2022 Gross Carrying Amount Accumulated Amortization Intangible Assets, net $ $ 4,000 $ 62,324 75,087 8,885 150,296 $ (3,267) $ (41,651) (37,984) (3,820) (86,722) $ 733 20,673 37,103 5,065 63,574 The following table summarizes amortization of intangible assets for future periods as of December 31, 2023: (In thousands) 2024 2025 2026 2027 2028 Thereafter Total NOTE 10. ACCRUED EXPENSES Accrued expenses as of December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively included the following: (In thousands) Compensation and other employee-related costs Legal and other settlements and expenses Accrued non-income taxes Royalties Rebates Other Total accrued expenses NOTE 11. DEBT Annual Amortization 118,084 113,798 110,354 109,249 105,783 367,336 924,603 $ $ December 31, 2023 140,817 $ 9,335 23,726 10,130 27,605 28,847 240,460 $ 2022 53,352 5,564 10,029 4,375 10,501 8,348 92,169 $ $ The carrying values of the Company’s 2025 Notes, acquired in the Merger, as of December 31, 2023, were as follows: 84 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (In thousands) 0.375% Senior Convertible Notes due 2025: Principal Unamortized fair value adjustment for acquisition accounting 0.375% Senior Convertible Notes due 2025 Embedded Conversion Option Debt, net of unamortized fair value adjustments for acquisition accounting Interest expense: Contractual coupon interest Amortization of fair value adjustments for acquisition accounting Total interest expense recognized on Senior Convertible Notes due 2025 Effective interest rates: Senior Convertible Notes due 2025 Line of Credit $ $ $ $ December 31, 2023 449,987 33,275 416,712 687 417,400 December 31, 2023 364 9,076 9,439 6.8% In September 2023, we entered into an unsecured credit agreement with U.S. Bank National Association, as administrative agent, Citizens Bank, N.A., as syndication agent, Royal Bank of Canada, as documentation agent, U.S. Bank National Association and Citizens Bank, N.A., as joint lead arrangers and joint book runners, and the other lenders referred to therein (the “September 2023 Credit Agreement”), that provides a revolving credit facility permitting borrowings up to $400.0 million and has a termination date of September 27, 2028. We may request an increase in the revolving commitments in an aggregate amount not to exceed (i) $200 million or (ii) so long as the Leverage Ratio (as defined in the September 2023 Credit Agreement) is at least 0.25 to 1.00 less than the applicable Leverage Ratio then required under the September 2023 Credit Agreement, an unlimited amount. Revolving Loans under the September 2023 Credit Agreement bear interest at either a base rate or the Term SOFR Rate (as defined in the Revolving Credit Facility) plus, in each case, an applicable margin, as determined in accordance with the provisions of the September 2023 Credit Agreement. The Applicable Margin ranges from 0.125% to 0.625% for the Base Rate and 1.125% to 1.625% for the Term SOFR Rate. We may also request Swingline Loans (as defined in the September 2023 Credit Agreement) at either the Base Rate or the Daily Term SOFR Rate. The September 2023 Credit Agreement is guaranteed by certain direct or indirect wholly owned subsidiaries of the Company. The September 2023 Credit Agreement contains financial and other customary covenants, including a funded net indebtedness to adjusted EBITDA ratio. As of December 31, 2023, we have not borrowed under the September 2023 Credit Agreement and we are compliance with all covenants. 0.375% Senior Convertible Notes due 2025 On September 1, 2023, in connection with the closing of the Merger, the Company, NuVasive and Wilmington Trust National Association, as trustee (the “Trustee”) entered into a supplemental agreement (the “First Supplemental Indenture”) to the Indenture, dated March 2, 2020 (the “Base Indenture”), by and between NuVasive and the Trustee, relating to NuVasive’s $450.0 million in aggregate principal amount of 0.375% Convertible Senior Notes due 2025. As of the closing date of the Merger, $450 million of aggregate principal amount of the 2025 Notes were outstanding. Pursuant to the First Supplemental Indenture, the 2025 Notes are convertible into the Company’s Class A common stock at a conversion rate of 8.0399 shares per $1,000 principal amount of 2025 Notes, which is equivalent to a conversion price of approximately $124.38 per share, subject to adjustments. The 2025 Notes may be settled in cash, stock, or a combination thereof, solely at the Company’s discretion. Pursuant to the terms of the First Supplemental Indenture, Globus agreed to guarantee NuVasive’s obligations under the Indenture. The 2025 Notes bear interest at a rate of 0.375% per annum, payable semi-annually in arrears on March 15 and September 15 of each year. The 2025 Notes mature on March 15, 2025, unless earlier converted, redeemed, or repurchased in accordance with their terms. The Merger constituted a Merger Event as defined in the Base Indenture. In the event of a Merger Event, the Company is required to execute a supplemental indenture providing for (i) each holder of 2025 Notes with the right to convert each $1,000 principal amount of 2025 Notes into the same type of consideration that holders would have been entitled to receive if such holders had held a number of shares of NuVasive Common Stock equal to the applicable conversion rate in effect immediately prior to such Merger Event, and (ii) subsequent adjustments to the conversion rate set forth in the Base Indenture. 85 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Prior to September 15, 2024, holders may convert their 2025 Notes only under the following conditions: (a) during any calendar quarter commencing after the calendar quarter ending on June 30, 2020 (and only during such calendar quarter), if the last reported sale price of the Company’s common stock for at least 20 trading days (whether or not consecutive) during a period of 30 consecutive trading days ending on, and including, the last trading day of the immediately preceding calendar quarter is greater than or equal to 130% of the conversion price on each applicable trading day; (b) during the five business day period after any five consecutive trading day period, or the measurement period, in which the trading price of the 2025 Notes per $1,000 principal amount of notes for each trading day of the measurement period was less than 98% of the product of the last reported sale price of the Company’s common stock and the conversion rate on such trading day; (c) if the Company calls any or all of the 2025 Notes for redemption, at any time prior to the close of business on the second scheduled trading day preceding the redemption date; or (d) upon the occurrence of specified corporate events, as defined in the 2025 Notes. On or after September 15, 2024, until the close of business on the second scheduled trading day immediately preceding March 15, 2025, holders may convert their 2025 Notes at any time, regardless of the foregoing conditions. In addition, following certain corporate events that occur prior to the maturity date or if the Company issues a notice of redemption, the Company will increase the conversion rate for a holder who elects to convert its 2025 Notes in connection with such a corporate event or in connection with such redemption in certain circumstances. The Company may redeem the 2025 Notes, at its option, in whole or in part, until the close of business on the business day immediately preceding September 15, 2024, if the last reported sale price of the Company’s common stock has been at least 130% of the conversion price then in effect for at least 20 trading days during any 30 consecutive trading day period ending on, and including, the trading day immediately preceding the date on which the Company delivers written notice of a redemption. The redemption price will be equal to 100% of the principal amount of such 2025 Notes to be redeemed plus accrued and unpaid interest to, but excluding, the redemption date. No principal payments are due on the 2025 Notes prior to maturity. Other than restrictions relating to certain fundamental changes and consolidations, mergers or asset sales and customary anti-dilution adjustments, the 2025 Notes do not contain any financial covenants and do not restrict the Company from conducting significant restructurings, paying dividends or issuing or repurchasing any of its other securities. Upon the initial recognition of the 2025 Notes pursuant to the purchase accounting for the Merger, the embedded conversion feature does not meet the equity scope exception described in ASC 815-40, Contracts in Entity’s Own Equity. The embedded conversion feature is bifurcated and presented as a liability on the consolidated balance sheet with subsequent measurement at fair value with changes in fair value recognized as other income/(expense). The Company recognized, at Merger closing, the embedded conversion feature at fair value of $1.7 million and allocated the residual $407.8 million of the 2025 Notes fair value to the host debt instrument. As of the December 31, 2023, the fair value of the embedded conversion feature was $0.7 million. As a result of the Merger and recognizing the fair value of the 2025 Notes, along with the embedded conversion feature, as of the acquisition date, the Company recorded $42.2 million debt discount to be accreted as interest expense over the life of the notes. 2025 Hedge On September 1, 2023, in connection with the closing of the Merger, the Company, NuVasive, and certain dealers entered into amendment and guarantee agreements with respect to 2025 Hedge pursuant to which NuVasive purchased options from such dealers exercisable into its own common stock in connection with the sale of the 2025 Notes. Pursuant to such amendment and guarantee agreements, the 2025 Hedge is exercisable into Globus Class A common stock in certain circumstances and the Company guaranteed NuVasive’s obligations under the 2025 Hedge. Subject to the amended 2025 Hedge, the Company is entitled to purchase up to 3,617,955 shares of the Company’s Class A common stock at a strike price of $124.38. The 2025 Hedge will expire on the second scheduled trading day immediately preceding March 15, 2025 and is expected to reduce the potential equity dilution upon conversion of the 2025 Notes if the daily volume-weighted average price per share of the Company’s common stock exceeds the strike price of the 2025 Hedge. In accordance with ASC 805, the Company recognized the 2025 Hedge at an acquisition date fair value of $1.7 million. The 2025 Hedge does not meet the equity scope exception described in ASC 815-40, Contract in Entity’s Own Equity, and will be presented as asset on the consolidated balance sheet with subsequent measurement at fair value with changes in fair value recognized as other income/(expense). As of December 31, 2023, the fair value of the 2025 Hedge is $0.7 million recorded within the Other Assets with the consolidated balance sheet. An assumed exercise of the 2025 Hedge by NuVasive is considered anti-dilutive since the effect of the inclusion would always be anti-dilutive with respect to the calculation of diluted earnings per share. 86 Table of Contents 2025 Warrants GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) On September 1, 2023, in connection with the closing of the Merger, the Company, NuVasive, and certain dealers entered into amendment and guarantee agreements with respect to the 2025 Warrants, pursuant to which NuVasive sold warrants to such dealers for its own common stock in connection with the initial sale of the 2025 Notes. Pursuant to such amendment and guarantee agreements, the warrants are exercisable into Globus Class A common stock in certain circumstances and the Company guaranteed NuVasive’s obligations under the 2025 Warrants. Subject to the amended 2025 Warrants, the holders of the 2025 Warrants are entitled to purchase up to 3,617,955 shares of the Company’s common stock at a strike price of $170.45. The 2025 Warrants will expire on various dates from June 2025 through October 2025 and may be settled in net shares or cash, at the Company’s election. In accordance with ASC 805, the Company recognized the 2025 Warrants at an acquisition date fair value of $0.6 million within additional paid- in capital. The 2025 Warrants could have a dilutive effect on the Company’s earnings per share to the extent that the price of the Company’s common stock during a given measurement period exceeds the strike price of the 2025 Warrants, which is $170.45 per share. The Company uses the treasury share method for assumed exercise of its 2025 Warrants to compute the weighted average common shares outstanding for diluted earnings per share. NOTE 12. EQUITY Stock Repurchases On March 11, 2020, the Company announced a share repurchase program, which authorized the Company to repurchase up to $200.0 million of the Company’s Class A common stock (“Class A Common”). On March 4, 2022, the share repurchase program was expanded by authorizing the Company to repurchase an additional $200.0 million of the Company’s Class A Common. On September 27, 2023, the share repurchase program was expanded by authorizing the Company to repurchase an additional $350.0 million of the Company’s Class A Common. The repurchase program has no time limit and may be suspended for periods or discontinued at any time. During the year ended December 31, 2023, the Company repurchased a total of 4.3 million shares under this program at an average price of $52.11, for a dollar amount of $225.6 million. As of December 31, 2023, the Company has approximately $275.2 million remaining under the share repurchase program authorized of Class A Common. The timing and actual number of shares repurchased will depend on various factors including price, corporate and regulatory requirements, debt covenant requirements, alternative investment opportunities and other market conditions. Funding of share repurchases is expected to come from operating cash flows and excess cash. Shares repurchased by the Company are accounted for under the constructive retirement method, in which the shares repurchased, are immediately retired, as there is no plan to reissue the shares. The Company made an accounting policy election to charge the excess of repurchase price over par value entirely to retained earnings. Common Stock Our amended and restated Certificate of Incorporation provides for a total of 775,000,000 authorized shares of common stock. Of the authorized number of shares of common stock, 500,000,000 shares are designated as Class A Common and 275,000,000 shares are designated as Class B common stock (“Class B Common”). The holders of Class A Common are entitled to one vote for each share of Class A Common held. Each share of our Class B common stock is convertible at any time at the option of the holder into one share of our Class A Common. In addition, each share of our Class B common stock will convert automatically into one share of our Class A common stock upon any transfer, whether or not for value, except for permitted transfers. For more details relating to the conversion of our Class B common stock please see “Exhibit 4.2, Description of Securities of the Registrant” filed herein. The holders of Class B Common are entitled to 10 votes for each share of Class B Common held. The holders of Class A Common and Class B Common vote together as one class of common stock. Except for voting rights, the Class A Common and Class B Common have the same rights and privileges. Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss) The tables below present the changes in each component of accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss), including current period other comprehensive income/(loss) and reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss) for the years ended December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively: 87 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (In thousands) Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax, at December 31, 2022 Other comprehensive income/(loss) before reclassifications Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax Other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax, at December 31, 2023 (In thousands) Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax, at December 31, 2021 Other comprehensive income/(loss) before reclassifications Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax Other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax, at December 31, 2022 Unrealized loss on marketable securities, net of tax Foreign currency translation adjustments $ $ (15,093) $ 17,420 (4,189) 13,231 (1,862) $ Accumulated other comprehensive loss (24,630) 18,627 (4,189) 14,438 (10,192) (9,537) $ 1,207 — 1,207 (8,330) $ Unrealized loss on marketable securities, net of tax Foreign currency translation adjustments $ $ (1,053) $ (18,494) 4,454 (14,040) (15,093) $ Accumulated other comprehensive loss (6,772) (22,312) 4,454 (17,858) (24,630) (5,719) $ (3,818) — (3,818) (9,537) $ Amounts reclassified from accumulated other comprehensive loss, net of tax, related to unrealized gains/losses on marketable securities were released to other income, net in our consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income. 88 Table of Contents Earnings Per Common Share GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) The Company computes basic earnings per share using the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the period. Diluted earnings per share assumes the conversion, exercise or issuance of all potential common stock equivalents, unless the effect of inclusion would be anti- dilutive. For purposes of this calculation, common stock equivalents include the Company’s stock options, unvested RSUs, and PRSUs. These are included in basic net income per share as of the date that all necessary conditions have been satisfied and are included in the denominator for dilutive calculation for the entire period if such shares would be issuable as of the end of the reporting period assuming the end of the reporting period was the end of the contingency period. The following table sets forth the computation of basic and diluted earnings per share: (In thousands, except per share amounts) Numerator: Net income/(loss) for basic: Dilutive potential net income (loss): Adjusted net income (loss) for diluted Denominator for basic and diluted net income per share: Weighted average shares outstanding for basic Dilutive stock options, RSUs, and PRSUs Weighted average shares outstanding for diluted Earnings per share: Basic Diluted Anti-dilutive stock options and RSUs excluded from the calculation Anti-dilutive warrants excluded from the calculation Anti-dilutive Senior Convertible Notes due 2025 excluded from the calculation Total $ $ $ $ Year Ended December 31, 2022 2021 2023 122,873 $ 190,169 $ 149,191 122,873 $ 190,169 $ 149,191 113,087 1,543 114,630 100,469 2,174 102,643 1.09 $ 1.07 $ 1.89 $ 1.85 $ 6,295 3,618 3,618 13,531 3,851 — — 3,851 100,734 2,889 103,623 1.48 1.44 2,139 — — 2,139 In accordance with ASU No. 2020-06, Debt with Conversion and Other Options (Subtopic 470-20), the Company applies the if-converted method in computing the effect of the Company's 2025 Notes on diluted net income per share. For periods in which the Company reports net income, the numerator of the diluted per share computation is adjusted for interest expense and amortization of debt issuance costs, net of tax, and the denominator is adjusted for the weighted average number of shares into which each of the Company’s 2025 Notes could be converted. The effect is only included in the calculation of diluted net income per share for those 2025 Notes which reduce net income per share. NOTE 13. STOCK-BASED AWARDS We have four stock plans: our 2012 Equity Incentive Plan (the “2012 Plan”) and our 2021 Equity Incentive Plan (the “2021 Plan”), the NuVasive 2014 Equity Incentive Plan (the “NuVasive 2014 Plan”), and the Ellipse Technologies 2015 Incentive Award Plan (the “Ellipse 2015 Plan”). The 2021 Plan, the NuVasive 2014 Plan and the Ellipse 2015 Plan are the only active stock plans. The purpose of the 2012 Plan was, and of the 2021 Plan is, to provide incentive to employees, directors, and consultants of Globus. The 2012 Plan, 2021 Plan, NuVasive 2014 Plan, and Ellipse 2015 Plan are administered by the Board of Directors of Globus (the “Board”) or its delegates. The number, type of option, exercise price, and vesting terms are determined by the Board or its delegates in accordance with the terms of the 2012 Plan and 2021 Plan. The options granted expire on a date specified by the Board, which is ten years from the grant date. Options granted to employees vest in varying installments over a four-year period. The 2012 Plan was approved by our Board in March 2012, and by our stockholders in June 2012. The 2012 Plan terminated as to new awards pursuant to its terms in 2022. Following effectiveness of the 2021 Plan, we have not issued any additional awards under the 2012 Plan; however, awards previously granted under the 2012 Plan remain outstanding and are administered by our Board under the terms and conditions of the 2012 Plan. Under the 2012 Plan, the aggregate number of shares of Class A Common stock that were able to be issued subject to options and other awards is equal to the sum of (i) 3,076,923 shares, (ii) any shares available for issuance under the 2008 Plan as of March 13, 2012, (iii) any shares underlying awards outstanding under the 2008 Plan as of March 13, 2012 that, on or after that date, are forfeited, terminated, 89 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) expired or lapse for any reason, or are settled for cash without delivery of shares and (iv) starting January 1, 2013, an annual increase in the number of shares available under the 2012 Plan equal to up to 3% of the number of shares of our common and preferred stock outstanding at the end of the previous year, as determined by our Board. The number of shares that were able to be issued or transferred pursuant to incentive stock options under the 2012 Plan was limited to 10,769,230 shares. The shares of Class A Common covered by the 2012 Plan included authorized but unissued shares, treasury shares or shares of common stock purchased on the open market. The 2021 Plan was approved by our Board in March 2021, and by our stockholders in June 2021. Under the 2021 Plan, as amended to date, the aggregate number of shares of Class A Common that were able to be issued subject to options and other awards is equal to the sum of (i) 8,000,000 shares, (ii) any shares available for issuance under the 2012 Plan as of June 3, 2021 and (iii) any shares underlying awards outstanding under the 2012 Plan or 2021 Plan as of June 3, 2021 that, on or after that date, are forfeited, terminated, expired or lapse for any reason, or are settled for cash without delivery of shares. The number of shares that could be issued or transferred pursuant to incentive stock options under the 2021 Plan is limited to 8,000,000 shares. The shares of Class A Common covered by the 2021 Plan include authorized but unissued shares, treasury shares or shares of common stock purchased on the open market. In connection with the Merger, the Company assumed outstanding awards for the RSUs and PRSUs under the NuVasive 2014 Plan and the Ellipse 2015 Plan in accordance with the terms in the Merger Agreement. The PRSUs ultimate issuance amount is determined by the Company’s Compensation Committee. Share payout levels range from 0% to 100% depending on the respective terms of an award. As of December 31, 2023, pursuant to the 2021 Plan, the NuVasive 2014 Plan, and the Ellipse 2015 Plan, there were 9,799,141 shares 2,271,633 shares, and 423,886 shares of Class A Common stock reserved, respectively and 5,152,998 shares, 1,625,088 shares, and 241,048 shares of Class A Common stock available, respectively, for future grants. Stock Options Stock option activity during the year ended December 31, 2023 is summarized as follows: Outstanding at December 31, 2022 Granted Exercised Forfeited Outstanding at December 31, 2023 Exercisable at December 31, 2023 Expected to vest at December 31, 2023 Option Shares (thousands) Weighted average exercise price Weighted average remaining contractual life (years) Aggregate intrinsic value (thousands) 10,338 $ 1,897 (387) (447) 11,401 7,103 4,292 $ 51.86 57.51 32.31 62.92 53.02 49.20 59.35 6.4 $ 5.3 8.2 $ 61,489 52,537 8,952 The total intrinsic value of stock options exercised was $10.8 million, $26.3 million, and $71.3 million, during the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021, respectively. The fair value of the options was estimated on the date of the grant using a Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following assumptions: Risk-free interest rate Expected term (years) Expected volatility Expected dividend yield Year Ended December 31, 3.45% 4.7 35.0% 2023 - - - —% 4.77% 4.8 38.0% 1.46% 4.7 33.0% 2022 - - - —% 4.04% 0.40% 9.9 35.0% 33.0% 2021 - 4.8 - —% 1.14% 34.0% The weighted average grant date fair value of stock options granted during the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021 was $21.47, $22.10, and $20.34 per share, respectively. 90 Table of Contents Restricted Stock Units GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) Restricted stock unit activity during the year ended December 31, 2023 is summarized as follows: Outstanding at December 31, 2022 Granted Vested Forfeited Outstanding at December 31, 2023 Performance-Based Restricted Stock Units Restricted Stock Units (thousands) Weighted average grant date fair value per share Weighted average remaining contractual life (years) 60 $ 1,271 (477) (34) 820 $ 67.40 54.04 — — 54.98 2.47 Performance-based restricted stock unit activity during the year ended December 31, 2023 is summarized as follows: Outstanding at December 31, 2022 Granted Vested Forfeited Outstanding at December 31, 2023 Stock-Based Compensation Performance-Based Restricted Stock Units (thousands) Weighted average grant date fair value per share Weighted average remaining contractual life (years) — $ 108 (2) — 106 $ — 53.61 54.10 — 53.61 2.47 Compensation expense related to stock options granted to employees and non-employees under the Plans and the intrinsic value of stock options exercised was as follows: (In thousands) Stock-based compensation expense Stock-based compensation expense classified in Acquisition-Related Costs Net stock-based compensation capitalized into inventory Total stock-based compensation cost $ $ 2023 38,995 $ 13,747 31 52,773 $ Year Ended December 31, 2022 32,810 $ — 657 33,467 $ 2021 30,586 — 667 31,253 As of December 31, 2023, there was $96.1 million of unrecognized compensation expense related to unvested employee stock options that vest over a weighted average period of three years. NOTE 14. INCOME TAXES The components of income before income taxes are as follows: (In thousands) Domestic Foreign Total $ $ 2023 181,752 $ (16,359) 165,393 $ Year Ended December 31, 2022 247,260 $ (4,241) 243,019 $ 2021 184,819 (4,412) 180,407 91 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) The components of the provision for income taxes are as follows: (In thousands) Current: Federal State Foreign Deferred: Federal State Foreign Total A reconciliation of the statutory U.S. federal tax rate to our effective rate is as follows: Statutory U.S. federal tax rate State income taxes, net of federal benefit Foreign taxes Valuation allowance Domestic production activities deduction Tax credits Compensation expense Nondeductible expenses Foreign inclusions Acquisition related charges Other Effective tax rate 2023 81,504 $ 15,190 4,075 100,769 (46,217) (6,421) (5,611) (58,249) 42,520 $ $ $ Year Ended December 31, 2022 60,927 $ 12,408 1,845 75,180 (16,429) (3,142) (2,759) (22,330) 52,850 $ Year Ended December 31, 2022 21.0 % 3.0 0.7 (0.5) — (1.3) (1.2) — — — — 21.7 % 2023 21.0 % 4.1 (0.6) 0.4 — (3.4) (0.9) 1.3 (0.9) 4.9 (0.2) 25.7 % 2021 37,436 7,688 3,741 48,865 (13,535) (2,265) (1,849) (17,649) 31,216 2021 21.0 % 2.7 1.6 0.1 (0.3) (1.5) (6.6) 0.5 — — (0.2) 17.3 % Deferred income taxes reflect the tax effects of temporary differences between the basis of assets and liabilities recognized for financial reporting purposes and tax purposes. Significant components of our deferred income taxes are as follows: 92 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) (In thousands) Deferred tax assets: Inventory reserve Accruals, reserves, and other currently not deductible Stock-based compensation Capitalized R&E Net operating loss carryforwards General business and other credit carryforwards Lease Liability Other Total deferred tax assets Valuation allowance Total deferred tax assets, net of valuation allowance Deferred tax liabilities: Depreciation and amortization Right of Use Asset Total deferred tax liabilities Net deferred tax assets/(liabilities) December 31, 2023 2022 $ $ 27,228 $ 37,798 39,715 68,832 128,810 42,569 22,887 30,948 398,787 (190,762) 208,025 (244,348) (12,370) (256,718) (48,693) $ 29,649 27,608 20,554 14,279 4,182 — — — 96,272 (5,488) 90,784 (43,718) — (43,718) 47,066 In assessing the realizability of deferred tax assets, management considers whether it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized. The ultimate realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon the generation of future taxable income during the periods in which those temporary differences become deductible. Based upon the level of historical taxable income and projections for future taxable income over the periods in which the deferred tax assets are deductible, management believes it is more likely than not that we will realize a portion of the benefits of these deductible differences at December 31, 2023 and 2022. The Company has established valuation allowances of $190.8 million and $5.5 million at December 31, 2023 and 2022, respectively, primarily related to the uncertainty of the utilization of certain deferred tax assets comprised of tax loss carryforwards in various jurisdictions. The increase in the valuation allowance during 2023 is primarily driven by acquired foreign deferred tax assets from the Merger that are not expected to be realized. The amount of the deferred tax asset considered realizable, however, could be reduced in the near term if estimates of future taxable income during the carryforward period are reduced. At December 31, 2023, the Company had $1.3 million, $51.7 million and $376.8 million of federal, state and foreign net operating loss carryforwards, respectively. Federal net operating loss carryforwards begin to expire in 2026, state net operating loss carryforwards begin to expire in 2023, and foreign net operating losses carry forward indefinitely. The Company has California research and development income tax credit carryforwards of $41.9 million. The California credits can be carried forward indefinitely. The Company has foreign tax credit carryforwards of $2.8 million which expire beginning in 2027. Due to the “change of ownership” provision of the Tax Reform Act of 1986, utilization of the Company’s net operating loss and credit carryforwards may be subject to an annual limitation against taxable income in future periods. As a result of any future ownership changes, the annual limitation of loss and credit carryforwards may cause them to expire before ultimately becoming available to reduce future income tax liabilities. A reconciliation of the beginning and ending amount of unrecognized tax benefits is as follows: (In thousands) Unrecognized tax benefits at the beginning of the year Additions related to current year tax positions Additions related to prior year tax positions Reductions related to prior year tax positions Unrecognized tax benefits at the end of the year $ $ 2023 986 $ 853 32,045 (127) 33,757 $ Year Ended December 31, 2022 1,052 $ — 50 (116) 986 $ 2021 1,600 — 160 (708) 1,052 The additions related to current year tax positions for the year ended December 31, 2023 of $0.9 million are primarily related to additional current year reserves. The additions related to the prior year tax positions for the year ended December 31, 2023 of $32.0 million 93 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) are related to the historical positions from the Merger, and recorded using the acquisition method of accounting. The reductions related to prior year tax positions for the year ended December 31, 2023 of $0.1 million are primarily related to the resolution of certain foreign tax positions. The impact of our unrecognized tax benefits to the effective income tax rate is as follows: (In thousands) Portion of total unrecognized tax benefits that, if recognized, would affect the effective income tax rate 2023 December 31, 2022 2021 $ 27,601 $ 1,355 $ 1,471 The undistributed earnings of our foreign subsidiaries as of December 31, 2023 are immaterial. Due to recent tax reform in the U.S. and favorable treaties between the U.S. and countries in which the Company’s controlled foreign corporations operate, the Company has the ability to repatriate earnings without incurring additional tax liabilities. Accordingly, the Company has not recorded a liability for taxes associated with any future distributions of these undistributed earnings. Interest and penalties are recorded in the statement of income as provision for income taxes. The total interest and penalties recorded in the statement of income was immaterial for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022, and 2021. We do not expect a significant change in our uncertain tax benefits in the next twelve months. We are subject to federal income tax as well as income tax of multiple state and foreign jurisdictions. With few exceptions, we are no longer subject to income tax examination by tax authorities in major jurisdictions for years prior to 2018 as of December 31, 2023. NOTE 15. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES We are involved in a number of proceedings, legal actions, and claims arising in the ordinary course of business. Such matters are subject to many uncertainties, and the outcomes of these matters are not within our control and may not be known for prolonged periods of time. In some actions, the claimants seek damages, as well as other relief, including injunctions prohibiting us from engaging in certain activities, which, if granted, could require significant expenditures and/or result in lost revenues. We record a liability in the consolidated financial statements for these actions when a loss is considered probable and the amount can be reasonably estimated. If the reasonable estimate of a probable loss is a range, and no amount in the range is a better estimate than any other, the minimum amount of the range is accrued. If a loss is reasonably possible but not known or probable, and can be reasonably estimated, the estimated loss or range of loss is disclosed. In most cases, significant judgment is required to estimate the amount and timing of a loss to be recorded. While it is not possible to predict the outcome for most of the matters discussed, we believe it is possible that costs associated with them could have a material adverse impact on our consolidated earnings, financial position or cash flows. Moskowitz Family LLC Litigation On November 20, 2019, Moskowitz Family LLC filed suit against us in the U.S. District Court for the Western District of Texas for patent infringement. Moskowitz, a non-practicing entity, alleges that Globus willfully infringes one or more claims of six patents by making, using, offering for sale or selling the COALITION®, COALITION MIS®, COALITION AGX®, CORBEL®, MONUMENT®, MAGNIFY®-S, HEDRON IATM, HEDRON IC®, INDEPENDENCE®, INDEPENDENCE MIS®, INDEPENDENCE MIS AGX®, FORTIFY® and XPAND® families, SABLE®, RISE®, RISE® INTRALIF, RISE®-L, ELSA®, ELSA® ATP, ALTERA®, ARIEL®, CALIBER® and CALIBER®-L products. Moskowitz seeks monetary damages and injunctive relief. On July 2, 2020, this suit was transferred from the U.S. District Court for the Western District of Texas to the U.S. District Court for the Eastern District of Pennsylvania. On December 14, 2023, a jury returned a defense verdict in favor of Globus. As such, we have not recorded a liability, outside of counsel fees, related to this litigation as of December 31, 2023. NOTE 16. LEASES The Company leases certain equipment, vehicles, office and storage facilities via various operating and financing lease agreements. Our leases have initial lease terms ranging from one year to seventeen years. Certain lease agreements require the Company to pay taxes, insurance, and maintenance, and provide for options to extend the term beyond the initial lease termination date. We use judgment to determine whether it is reasonably possible that we will extend the lease beyond the initial term and the length of the possible extension. Leases that have terms of less than 12 months are treated as short-term and we do not recognize right-of-use assets or lease liabilities for such leases. We generally estimate discount rates using our incremental borrowing rate, and based on other information available, at commencement date of a lease when determining the present value of future payments, as most of our leases do not provide an implicit rate. The Company has security deposits recorded and maintained in Other Assets totaling $1.5 million as of December 31, 2023. The Company includes financing lease right-of-use assets in other assets, short-term financing lease liabilities in accrued expenses, and long-term financing lease liabilities in other liabilities on the consolidated balance sheet. Operating lease expense is recognized on a 94 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) straight-line basis over the term of the lease as a component of operating income on the consolidated statement of operations and comprehensive income. Finance leases amortize the right-of-use assets and amortize the interest on the lease liability over the term of the lease. Amounts reported in the consolidated balance sheet were as follows: (In thousands) Asset: Operating lease right-of-use asset Finance lease right-of-use asset Total leased assets Liabilities: Current: Operating lease liability Finance lease liability Long-term: Operating lease liability Finance lease liability Total lease liabilities December 31, 2023 December 31, 2022 $ $ $ 59,931 $ 797 60,728 $ 11,967 475 91,037 337 103,816 $ 5,988 - 5,988 2,536 - 3,475 - 6,011 The table below summarizes the Company’s lease costs arising from the operating and financing lease obligations: (In thousands) Lease expense: Operating lease expense Finance lease expense: Depreciation of right-of-use asset Interest expense on lease liabilities Total lease expense Future minimum lease payments under non-cancellable leases as of December 31, 2023 are as follows: Twelve Months Ended December 30, 2023 2022 $ $ 19,471 $ 2,588 903 67 20,441 $ - - 2,588 (In thousands) 2024 2025 2026 2027 2028 Thereafter Total minimum lease payments Less: amount representing interest Present value of obligations under leases Less: current portion Long-term lease obligations Finance Leases Operating Leases 498 182 170 — — — 850 (38) 812 (475) 337 $ $ $ 18,336 14,931 13,431 12,352 11,281 74,018 144,350 (41,346) 103,004 (11,967) 91,037 $ $ $ 95 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) The table below summarizes the Company’s supplemental cash flow information and assumptions used: (In thousands, except weighted average lease term and discount rate) Other supplemental cash flow information: Cash paid for amounts included in measurement of lease liabilities Operating cash flows from operating leases Operating cash flows for finance leases Financing cash flows for finance leases Total cash paid for amounts included in the measurement of lease liabilities Right-of-use assets obtained in exchange for lease obligations Operating leases Financing leases Weighted-average remaining lease term Operating leases Financing leases Weighted-average discount rate Operating leases Financing leases NOTE 17. RETIREMENT BENEFIT PLANS December 31, December 31, December 31, 2023 2022 2021 $ $ $ $ 19,773 $ 67 913 20,753 $ 2,545 $ — — 2,545 $ 9,043 $ - $ 1,915 $ - $ 14.9 2.6 8.3% 4.4% 2.4 - 3.5% - 1,743 — — 1,743 1,436 - 1.8 - 2.7% - We sponsor 401(k) Plans covering all eligible U.S. employees, and a retirement plan for all eligible Puerto Rico employees. Under the 401(k) Plans, we make matching contributions ranging from 3% to 4% of the employee’s compensation for the period. Additionally, we contribute to various foreign retirement benefit plans required by local law or coordinated with government sponsored plans which cover many of our international employees. The benefits offered under these plans are reflective of local customs and practices in the countries concerned. Company contributions to these retirement plans were as follows: (In thousands) 401(k) and other retirement plan contributions NOTE 18. SEGMENT AND GEOGRAPHIC INFORMATION 2023 Year Ended December 31, 2022 $ 10,525 $ 7,154 $ 2021 6,588 Operating segments are defined as components of an organization for which separate financial information is available and evaluated regularly by the chief operating decision maker, or decision-making group, in deciding how to allocate resources and in assessing performance. We have identified two operating segments, Musculoskeletal Solutions and Enabling Technologies, based on how management reviews the business, makes investing and resource allocation decisions and assesses operating performance. We aggregate these operating segments into one reportable segment, based on conclusions reached after considering the factors including economic similarity, customer base, regulatory environment, production processes, nature of services and products provided, and our comprehensive approach to product development and offerings targeting patient needs through procedural-based solutions. 96 Table of Contents GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued) The following table represents total net sales and property and equipment, net by geographic area, based on the location of the customer for the years ended December 31, 2023, 2022 and 2021, respectively: (In thousands) United States International Total $ $ 2023 1,279,765 288,711 1,568,476 $ $ Net Sales Year Ended December 31, 2022 Property and Equipment, Net Year Ended December 31, 2021 2023 2022 871,939 150,904 1,022,843 $ $ 819,571 $ 138,531 958,102 $ 527,332 $ 59,600 586,932 $ 237,680 6,049 243,729 97 Table of Contents Item 9. Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure None. Item 9A. Controls and Procedures Evaluation of Disclosure Controls and Procedures Our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended) are designed to ensure that information required to be disclosed in the reports that we file or submit under the Exchange Act is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the rules and forms of the Securities and Exchange Commission and to ensure that information required to be disclosed is accumulated and communicated to management, including our principal executive officer and principal financial officer, to allow timely decisions regarding disclosure. The Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Financial Officer have reviewed the design and effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures as of December 31, 2023 and, based on their evaluation, have concluded that the disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of such date. Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting Management of Globus is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting, as defined in Rule 13a- 15(f) and Rule 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act. Internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable, but not absolute, assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the Company; provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America, and that receipts and expenditures of the Company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the Company; and provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the Company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements. Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate. Our management has performed its assessment of our internal control over financial reporting according to the guidelines established by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission in Internal Control-Integrated Framework (2013) (“COSO”). Management excluded NuVasive from its assessment of internal control over financial reporting, as it was not possible to conduct an assessment of NuVasive’s internal control over financial reporting in the period between the Merger date and the date of management’s assessment. NuVasive accounted for approximately 26% of total assets as of December 31, 2023, and 26% of the total revenue for the year ended December 31, 2023. Based on the foregoing and as a result of this assessment and based on the criteria in the COSO framework, management has concluded that, as of December 31, 2023, the internal control over financial reporting of Globus was effective. Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm Deloitte & Touche LLP, our independent registered public accounting firm, has audited the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2023 as stated in their report that is included in Item 8 of this Form 10-K. Changes in Internal Control over Financial Reporting There was no change in our internal control over financial reporting identified in connection with the evaluation required by Rule 13a-15(d) and 15d-15(d) of the Exchange Act that occurred during our most recent fiscal quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting. Item 9B. Other Information On December 14, 2023, David D. Davidar, Director, adopted a trading arrangement for the sale of securities of the Company’s Class A common stock that is intended to satisfy the affirmative defense conditions of Securities Exchange Act Rule 10b5-1(c) (a “Rule 10b5-1 Trading Plan”). Mr. Davidar’s Rule 10b5-1 Trading Plan, which has a term ending upon the earlier of March 14, 2025 or the 98 Table of Contents sale of all shares subject to the plan, provides for the sale of up to 70,000 shares of Class A common stock pursuant to the terms of the plan. On December 14, 2023, The Davidar Family Irrevocable Trust, whose shares are beneficially owned by David D. Davidar, adopted a Rule 10b5-1 Trading Plan. The Davidar Family Irrevocable Trust’s Rule 10b5-1 Trading Plan, which has a term ending upon the earlier of March 14, 2025 or the sale of all shares subject to the plan, provides for the sale of up to 40,000 shares of Class A common stock pursuant to the terms of the plan. On December 14, 2023, Leslie V. Norwalk, Director, adopted a Rule 10b5-1 Trading Plan to sell $550,000 worth of the Company’s Class A common stock on a date certain after the 90-day cooling-off period set forth in the plan, and, separately, up to 1,000 shares of Company common stock over a period beginning on March 15, 2024 and ending on December 31, 2024, subject to certain conditions. On December 15, 2023, Keith W. Pfeil, the Company’s Chief Operating Officer and Chief Financial Officer, adopted a Rule 10b5-1 Trading Plan. Mr. Pfeil’s Rule 10b5-1 Trading Plan, which has a term ending upon the earlier of March 15, 2025 or the sale of all shares subject to the plan, provides for the sale of up to 99,376 shares of Class A common stock pursuant to the terms of the plan. 99 Table of Contents PART III Certain information required by Part III is omitted from this Annual Report and will be included in the definitive proxy statement for our 2024 annual meeting of stockholders, which will be filed within 120 days after the end of our fiscal year. Item 9C. Disclosure Regarding Foreign Jurisdictions that Prevent inspections Not applicable. Item 10. Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance Code of Ethics We have adopted a Code of Ethics for all employees, officers, directors, as well as a Code of Ethics specifically for our principal executive officer and senior financial officers, both of which are available on our website, www.globusmedical.com. We intend to disclose future amendments to, or waivers from, provisions of our Code of Ethics that apply to our Principal Executive Officer, Principal Financial Officer, Principal Accounting Officer, or Controller, or persons performing similar functions, within four business days of such amendment or waiver. The other information required by this Item 10 will be set forth in the Company’s proxy statement for its 2024 annual meeting of stockholders, which information is incorporated herein by reference. Item 11. Executive Compensation The information required by this Item 11 will be set forth in the Company’s proxy statement for its 2024 annual meeting of stockholders, which information is incorporated herein by reference. Item 12. Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters The information required by this Item 12 will be set forth in the Company’s proxy statement for its 2024 annual meeting of stockholders, which information is incorporated herein by reference. Item 13. Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence The information required by this Item 13 will be set forth in the Company’s proxy statement for its 2024 annual meeting of stockholders, which information is incorporated herein by reference. Item 14. Principal Accountant Fees and Services The information required by this Item 14 will be set forth in the Company’s proxy statement for its 2024 annual meeting of stockholders, which information is incorporated herein by reference. 100 Table of Contents Item 15. Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules (a) (1) Financial Statements PART IV Reports of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm ( Deloitte & Touche LLP, Philadelphia, Pennsylvania, PCAOB ID No. 34) Consolidated Balance Sheets Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income Consolidated Statements of Equity Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements 64 65 66 67 68 69 (a) (2) Financial Statement Schedules SCHEDULE II. VALUATION ACCOUNTS AND QUALIFYING ACCOUNTS Allowance for doubtful accounts: (In thousands) Year ended December 31, 2021 Year ended December 31, 2022 Year ended December 31, 2023 Deferred tax valuation allowance: (In thousands) Year ended December 31, 2021 Year ended December 31, 2022 Year ended December 31, 2023 Beginning of period Charged to expenses Write-offs $ $ 4,408 4,962 4,724 $ $ $ 1,200 (1) 3,658 $ $ $ (646) $ (237) $ 552 $ End of period 4,962 4,724 8,934 Additions Beginning of period Charged to expenses Charged to other accounts $ $ 6,487 $ 6,594 $ 5,488 $ 107 (1,106) 8,301 $ $ $ — — 176,974 $ $ $ Deductions Other deductions End of period 6,594 5,488 190,763 — $ — $ — $ 101 Table of Contents (b) Exhibits, including those incorporated by reference 102 Table of Contents Exhibit No. 2.1 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 4.1 4.2* 4.3 4.4 4.5 10.1 10.2 10.3 10.4 10.5 10.6 10.7 10.8 10.9 10.10 10.11 10.12 10.13 Item Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of February 8, 2023, by and among NuVasive, Inc., Globus Medical, Inc. and Zebra Merger Sub, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to Globus Medical, Inc.’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on February 9, 2023) Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of Globus Medical, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Registrant’s Amendment No. 5 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on August 2, 2012). Certificate of Amendment of the Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of Globus Medical, Inc., dated July 30, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 of the Registrant’s Amendment No. 5 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on August 2, 2012). Certificate of Amendment of the Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation of Globus Medical, Inc., dated August 7, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 of the Registrant’s Form 10-Q/A filed on September 19, 2012). Amended and Restated Bylaws of Globus Medical, Inc. effective as of May 1, 2019 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to our Form 10-Q/A filed on May 2, 2019). Amendment to Bylaws effective as of July 31, 2021 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to our Form 10-Q filed on August 4, 2021). Specimen Certificate for Class A Common Stock (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of the Registrant’s Amendment No. 3 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on July 16, 2012). Description of Securities of the Registrant. Indenture, dated as of March 2, 2020, between NuVasive and the Trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to NuVasive, Inc.’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on March 2, 2020). First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of September 1, 2023, among Globus, NuVasive and the Trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 1, 2023). Form of 0.375% Convertible Senior Note due 2025 (incorporated by reference to NuVasive, Inc.’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on March 2, 2020) Globus Medical, Inc. 2012 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 of the Registrant’s Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on May 8, 2012). Form of Incentive Stock Option Grant Notice and Incentive Stock Option Agreement under 2012 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.10 of the Registrant’s Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on May 8, 2012). Form of Nonqualified Stock Option Grant Notice and Nonqualified Stock Option Agreement under 2012 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.11 of the Registrant’s Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on May 8, 2012). Form of Indemnification Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.18 of the Registrant’s Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on May 8, 2012). Form of No Competition and Non-Disclosure Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.19 of the Registrant’s Amendment No. 1 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 filed on May 8, 2012). Executive Employment Agreement, dated May 3, 2016 by and between Globus Medical, Inc. and Daniel T. Scavilla (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to our Form 10-Q filed on May 4, 2016). Executive Employment Agreement, dated August 5, 2020 by and between Globus Medical, Inc. and Kelly Huller (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to our Form 10-Q filed on August 5, 2020). Executive Employment Agreement, dated August 5, 2020 by and between Globus Medical, Inc. and Keith Pfeil (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to our Form 10-Q filed on August 5, 2020). Globus Medical, Inc. 2021 Equity Incentive Plan, as amended (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to our Form 8-K filed on June 8, 2023). Globus Medical, Inc. 2021 Equity Incentive Plan Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.5 to our Form S-8 filed on December, 16, 2021). Globus Medical, Inc. 2021 Equity Incentive Plan Nonqualified Stock Option Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.6 to our Form S-8 filed on December, 16, 2021). Globus Medical, Inc. 2021 Equity Incentive Plan Restricted Stock Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.7 to our Form S-8 filed on December, 16, 2021). Globus Medical, Inc. 2021 Equity Incentive Plan Incentive Stock Option Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.8 to our Form S-8 filed on December, 16, 2021). 103 Table of Contents 10.14 10.15 10.16 10.17 10.18 10.19 10.20 10.21 10.22 10.23 10.24 10.25 10.26 10.27 10.28 10.29 10.30 Indenture, dated as of March 2, 2020, between NuVasive and the Trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to NuVasive, Inc.’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on March 2, 2020). First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of September 1, 2023, among Globus, NuVasive and the Trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 1, 2023). Credit Agreement, dated as of September 27, 2023, by and among the Company, U.S. Bank National Association, as administrative agent, Citizens Bank, N.A., as syndication agent, and Royal Bank of Canada, as documentation agent, U.S. Bank National Association and Citizens Bank, N.A. as joint lead arrangers and joint book runners, and the other lenders referred to therein (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on October 2, 2023). Guaranty, dated as of September 27, 2023, by and among U.S. Bank National Association, as administrative agent, and NuVasive, Inc., NuVasive Clinical Services Monitoring, Inc. and Branch Medical Group, as guarantors (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the SEC on October 2, 2023). 2014 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit A to NuVasive Inc.'s Definitive Proxy Statement filed with the Commission on March 27, 2014) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). 2015 Ellipse Technologies, Inc. Incentive Award Plan (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Registration Statement on Form S-8 filed with the Commission on February 11, 2016). Lease for Sorrento Summit, dated as of August 28, 2017, by and between HCPI/Sorrento, LLC and the Company (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on August 29, 2017). Confirmation for base call option transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc and the Company (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020). Confirmation for base call option transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association and the Company (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020). Confirmation for base call option transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between Royal Bank of Canada and the Company (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020). Confirmation for base call option transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between The Bank of Nova Scotia and the Company (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020). Confirmation for base call option transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between Barclays Bank PLC and the Company (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020). Confirmation for base warrant transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc and the Company (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020). Confirmation for base warrant transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association and the Company (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020). Confirmation for base warrant transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between Royal Bank of Canada and the Company (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020). Confirmation for base warrant transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between The Bank of Nova Scotia and the Company (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020). Confirmation for base warrant transaction dated as of February 26, 2020, between Barclays Bank PLC and the Company (incorporated by reference to NuVasive Inc.'s Current Report on Form 8-K filed with the Commission on March 2, 2020). 104 Table of Contents 10.31 10.32 10.33 10.34 10.35 10.36 10.37 10.38 10.39 10.40 10.41 10.42 10.43 10.44 10.45 10.46 10.47 10.48 Bond Hedge Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Barclays Bank PLC and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.18 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Bond Hedge Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Barclays Bank PLC and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.19 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Warrant Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Barclays Bank PLC and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.20 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Warrant Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Barclays Bank PLC and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.21 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Bond Hedge Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.22 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Bond Hedge Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.23 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Warrant Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.24 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Warrant Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between JPMorgan Chase Bank, National Association and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.25 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Bond Hedge Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.26 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Bond Hedge Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.27 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Warrant Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.28 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Warrant Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.29 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Bond Hedge Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between The Bank of Nova Scotia and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.30 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Bond Hedge Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between The Bank of Nova Scotia and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.31 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Warrant Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between The Bank of Nova Scotia and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.32 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Warrant Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between The Bank of Nova Scotia and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.33 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Bond Hedge Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Royal Bank of Canada and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.34 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Bond Hedge Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Royal Bank of Canada and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.35 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). 105 Table of Contents 10.49 10.50 21.1* 23.1* 31.1* 31.2* 32** 97.1* 101.INS* 101.SCH* 101.CAL* 101.LAB* 101.PRE* 101.DEF* 104 * ** *** Warrant Amendment Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Royal Bank of Canada and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.36 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Warrant Guarantee Agreement, dated as of September 1, 2023, between Royal Bank of Canada and the Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.37 to Globus Medical, Inc.'s Current Report on Form 10-Q filed with the SEC on November 7, 2023). Subsidiaries of Globus Medical, Inc. Consent of independent registered public accounting firm – Deloitte & Touche LLP. Certification by Principal Executive Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. Certification by Principal Financial Officer pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. Certifications pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002. Globus Compensation Recoupment Policy XBRL Instance Document – the instance document does not appear in the Interactive Data File because its XBRL tags are embedded within the Inline XBRL document. XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document Cover Page Interactive Data File (formatted as Inline XBRL and contained in Exhibit 101) Filed herewith. Furnished herewith. Schedules and exhibits have been omitted pursuant to Item 601(b)(2) of Regulation S-K. The Registrant agrees to furnish on a supplemental basis a copy of the omitted schedules and exhibits to the Commission upon request. Item 16. Form 10-K Summary None. 106 Table of Contents Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized. SIGNATURES Dated: February 20, 2024 /s/ DANIEL T. SCAVILLA GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. Daniel T. Scavilla Chief Executive Officer President (Principal Executive Officer) Dated: February 20, 2024 /s/ KEITH PFEIL Keith Pfeil Chief Financial Officer and Chief Operating Officer Chief Accounting Officer Senior Vice President (Principal Financial Officer) 107 Table of Contents Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated. SIGNATURE TITLE President and Chief Executive Officer (Principal Executive Officer) and Director Chief Financial Officer and Chief Operating Officer Chief Accounting Officer Senior Vice President (Principal Financial Officer) DATE February 20, 2024 February 20, 2024 /s/ DANIEL T. SCAVILLA Daniel T. Scavilla /s/ KEITH PFEIL Keith Pfeil /s/ DAVID C. PAUL David C. Paul /s/ DAVID D. DAVIDAR David D. Davidar /s/ ROBERT DOUGLAS Robert Douglas /s/ DANIEL T. LEMAITRE Daniel T. Lemaitre /s/ ANN D. RHOADS Ann D. Rhoads /s/ JAMES R. TOBIN James R. Tobin /s/ STEPHEN T. ZARRILLI Stephen T. Zarrilli /s/ JOHN A. DEFORD John A. DeFord /s/ DANIEL J. WOLTERMAN Daniel J. Wolterman /s/ LESLIE V. NORWALK Leslie V. Norwalk Executive Chairman and Director February 20, 2024 Director Director Director Director Director Director Director Director Director 108 February 20, 2024 February 20, 2024 February 20, 2024 February 20, 2024 February 20, 2024 February 20, 2024 February 20, 2024 February 20, 2024 February 20, 2024 DESCRIPTION OF THE REGISTRANT’S SECURITIES REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12 OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 EXHIBIT 4.2 As of December 31, 2023, Globus Medical, Inc. (the “Company”, “our”, “us”, or “we”) had one class of securities registered under Section 12 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”): Class A common stock, par value $.001 per share. The Company’s Class A common stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange under the trading symbol “GMED”. DESCRIPTION OF COMMON STOCK The following is a description of the rights of our Class A and Class B common stock and related provisions of the Company’s Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation (the “Certificate”), Amended and Restated Bylaws (the “Bylaws”), and applicable Delaware law. This description is qualified in its entirety by, and should be read in conjunction with, the Certificate, Bylaws, and applicable Delaware law. Authorized Capital Stock The Company’s authorized capital stock consists of 500,000,000 shares of Class A common stock and 275,000,000 shares of Class B common stock. The Company is authorized to issue up to 35,000,000 shares of preferred stock. As of December 31, 2023, the Company does not have any issued or outstanding shares of preferred stock. Common Stock Fully Paid and Nonassessable All of the outstanding shares of the Company’s common stock are fully paid and nonassessable. Voting Rights Holders of our Class A and Class B common stock have identical voting rights, except that holders of our Class A common stock are entitled to one vote per share and holders of our Class B common stock are entitled to 10 votes per share. Holders of shares of our Class A and Class B common stock will vote together as a single class on all matters (including the election of directors) submitted to a vote of stockholders, unless otherwise required by law or the Certificate. Delaware law could require either our Class A common stock or our Class B common stock to vote separately as a single class in the following circumstances: · · If we were to seek to amend the Certificate or increase or decrease the authorized number of shares of a class of stock, or to increase or decrease the par value of a class of stock, then that class would be required to vote separately to approve the proposed amendment; and If we were to seek to amend the Certificate in a manner that altered or changed the powers, preferences or special rights of a class of stock in a manner that affected them adversely, then that class would be required to vote separately to approve the proposed amendment. We have not provided for cumulative voting for the election of directors in the Certificate. Our Board of Directors (the “Board”) is divided into three classes, which are as nearly equal in number as possible, with each director elected at an annual stockholders’ meeting serving a three-year term and one class being elected at each year’s annual meeting of stockholders. Dividend Rights Subject to preferences that may apply to any shares of preferred stock outstanding at the time, if any, the holders of outstanding shares of Class A and Class B common stock are entitled to receive dividends out of funds legally available at the times and in the amounts that the Board may determine. Dividends may be paid in cash, in property, or in shares of the Company’s capital stock. If dividends are paid in shares of stock or rights to purchase shares of stock, the holders of Class A common stock will receive shares of Class A common stock or rights to purchase shares of Class A common stock and the holders of Class B common stock will receive shares of Class B common stock or rights to purchase shares of Class B common stock. Right to Receive Liquidation Distributions Upon the Company’s liquidation, dissolution, distribution of assets or winding-up, the assets legally available for distribution to stockholders would be distributable ratably among the holders of Class A and Class B common stock and any participating preferred stock outstanding at that time, if any, after payment of liquidation preferences, if any, on any outstanding shares of preferred stock and payment of other claims of creditors. No Preemptive or Similar Rights Neither Class A nor Class B common stock is entitled to preemptive rights, and neither is subject to redemption. There are no sinking fund provisions applicable to the Company’s common stock. Conversion Our Class A common stock is not convertible into any other shares of our capital stock. Each share of our Class B common stock is convertible at any time at the option of the holder into one share of our Class A common stock. In addition, each share of our Class B common stock will convert automatically into one share of our Class A common stock upon any transfer, whether or not for value, except for permitted transfers. Class B common stockholders may transfer shares of Class B common stock in the following manner without having the shares of Class B common stock convert to Class A common stock: · · · · · · the granting of a proxy to officers or directors of the Company whether or not at the request of the Board in connection with actions to be taken at an annual or special meeting of stockholders; entering into a voting trust, agreement or arrangement (with or without granting a proxy) pursuant to which voting control is granted over such share to an officer or director of the Company that does not involve any payment of cash, securities, property or other consideration to the Class B stockholder other than the mutual promise to vote shares in a designated manner; a transfer by a stockholder who is an individual upon such stockholder’s death pursuant to a will or the laws of descent and distribution; any transfer of convertible securities; any transfer to an affiliate; or any transfer by an individual stockholder to, or for the benefit of, any spouse or any ancestor, descendant, sibling, or child of a sibling of such stockholder or his or her spouse, or any transfer by a stockholder to a trust, limited partnership or limited liability company for the benefit of such individual stockholder or any such family member, or any transfer by such a trust, partnership or limited liability company to any such stockholder or family member. With respect to each holder of one or more shares of our Class B common stock, each of such holder’s shares of Class B common stock will automatically convert into one share of our Class A common stock if: · such holder’s shares of Class B common stock, together with the shares of Class B common stock then held by that holder’s affiliates, represents less than 5% of the aggregate number of all outstanding shares of our common stock. Once converted into Class A common stock, Class B common stock cannot be reissued. Anti-Takeover Provisions of the Certificate, Bylaws, and Delaware Law The provisions of Delaware law, our dual class structure, the Certificate and Bylaws may have the effect of delaying, deferring or discouraging another person from acquiring control of our company. Delaware Law We are governed by the provisions of Section 203 of the Delaware General Corporation Law. In general, Section 203 prohibits a public Delaware corporation from engaging in a “business combination” with an “interested stockholder” for a period of three years after the date of prescribed manner. A “business combination” includes mergers, asset sales or other transactions resulting in a financial benefit to the stockholder. An “interested stockholder” is a person who, together with affiliates and associates, owns, or within three years did own, 15% or more of the corporation’s outstanding voting stock. These provisions may have the effect of delaying, deferring or preventing a change in our control. Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation and Amended and Restated Bylaw Provisions The Certificate and Bylaws provide for a dual class structure and include a number of other provisions that could deter hostile takeovers or delay or prevent changes in control of our management team, including the following: Dual Class Structure As discussed above, our Class B common stock has 10 votes per share, while our Class A common stock has one vote per share. David C. Paul, a director and our current Executive Chairman, and his affiliates, in the aggregate, beneficially own 100% of our outstanding Class B common stock, representing approximately 65.8% of the total voting power of our outstanding capital stock. Because of our dual class structure, the holders of our Class B common stock will continue to be able to control all matters submitted to our stockholders for approval even if they own significantly less than 50% of the shares of our outstanding common stock. This concentrated control could discourage others from initiating any potential merger, takeover or other change of control transaction that other stockholders might view as beneficial. The Board is authorized, without stockholder approval, to issue additional authorized shares of our Class A and Class B common stock. Board of Directors Vacancies The Certificate and Bylaws authorize our board of directors or stockholders (at a duly convened meeting) to fill vacant directorships. Classified Board The Bylaws provide that the Board is classified into three classes of directors. This could delay a successful tender offeror from obtaining majority control of the Board, and the prospect of that delay might deter a potential offeror. In addition, stockholders are not permitted to cumulate their votes for the election of directors. Stockholder Action; Special Meeting of Stockholders The Bylaws provide that our stockholders may not take action by written consent, but may only take action at annual or special meetings of our stockholders. The Bylaws further provide that special meetings of our stockholders may be called only by a majority of our board of directors. Advance Notice Requirements for Stockholder Proposals and Director Nominations The Bylaws provide advance notice procedures for stockholders seeking to bring business before our annual meeting of stockholders, or to nominate candidates for election as directors at our annual meeting of stockholders. To be timely, a stockholder’s notice must be delivered to, or mailed and received at, our principal executive offices not more than 90 nor less than 50 days prior to the meeting with respect to an annual meeting of stockholders, and not later than 10 business days after public announcement of a special meeting. The Bylaws also specify certain requirements regarding the form and content of a stockholder’s notice. These provisions might preclude our stockholders from bringing matters before our annual meeting of stockholders or from making nominations for directors at our annual meeting of stockholders. Preferred Stock The Board has the authority, without further action by our stockholders, to issue up to 35,000,000 shares of undesignated preferred stock with rights and preferences, including voting, dividend, redemption, liquidation or preemptive rights, designated from time to time by the Board, which could be in preference or priority to the rights of holders of our Class A and Class B common stock. The Board may utilize such shares for a variety of corporate purposes, including future public offerings to raise additional capital, corporate acquisitions and employee benefit plans. Also, the existence of authorized but unissued shares of preferred stock would enable the Board to render more difficult or to discourage an attempt to obtain control of us by means of a merger, tender offer, proxy contest or other means. If we issue such shares without stockholder approval and in violation of limitations imposed by the New York Stock Exchange or any stock exchange on which our stock may then be trading, our stock could be delisted. Listing The Company’s Class A common stock is listed on the New York Stock Exchange under the trading symbol “GMED”. Subsidiaries of Globus Medical, Inc. EXHIBIT 21.1 The following is a list of our subsidiaries as of December 31, 2023, omitting subsidiaries which, considered in the aggregate, would not constitute a significant subsidiary as defined by Rule 1-02(w) of Regulation S-X. Subsidiary Globus Medical North America, Inc. Branch Medical Group, LLC NuVasive, Inc. NuVasive Technology International Limited KB Medical SA Synoste OY Nemaris Inc. Globus Medical SARL MIS Spine Comercials de R.L. de C.V. Globus Medical Brazil LDTA Globus Medical Italy S.r.l American Neuromonitoring Associates, P.C. Simplify Medical Pty. Globus Medical Netherlands Biologics NuVasive Netherlands Coopertief U.A. NuVasive Netherlands B.V. NuVasive Clinical Services Monitoring Inc. NuVasive Japan K.K. NuVasive Specialized Orthopedics, Inc. NuVasive Germany GmbH NuVasive Italia S.r.l. Globus Medical Japan GK NuVasive (AUST/NZ) Pty. Ltd. Jurisdiction Pennsylvania Delaware Delaware Malta Switzerland Finland Delaware Switzerland Mexico Brazil Italy Maryland Australia Netherlands Netherlands Netherlands Delaware Japan Delaware Germany Italy Japan Australia Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm We consent to the incorporation by reference in Registration Statement on Form S-8 (Nos. 333-275809, 333-261694, 333-198698 and 333-184196) of our reports dated February 20, 2024, relating to the financial statements and financial statement schedule of Globus Medical, Inc. and the effectiveness of Globus Medical, Inc.’s internal control over financial reporting appearing in this Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2023. EXHIBIT 23.1 /s/ DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP Philadelphia, Pennsylvania February 20, 2024 EXHIBIT 31.1 I, Daniel T. Scavilla, certify that: Certification By Principal Executive Officer Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 1. 2. 3. 4. I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K of Globus Medical, Inc.; Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report; Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations, and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report; The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e)) and 15d-15(e) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have: a) b) c) d) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared; Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles; Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and 5. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions): a) b) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize, and report financial information; and Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting. Date: February 20, 2024 /s/ DANIEL T. SCAVILLA Daniel T. Scavilla Chief Executive Officer President (Principal Executive Officer) EXHIBIT 31.2 I, Keith Pfeil, certify that: Certification By Principal Financial Officer Pursuant to Section 302 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 1. 2. 3. 4. I have reviewed this Annual Report on Form 10-K of Globus Medical, Inc.; Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report; Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations, and cash flows of the registrant as of, and for, the periods presented in this report; The registrant’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the registrant and have: a) b) c) d) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the registrant, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared; Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles; Evaluated the effectiveness of the registrant’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and Disclosed in this report any change in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the registrant’s most recent fiscal quarter (the registrant’s fourth fiscal quarter in the case of an annual report) that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting; and 5. The registrant’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the registrant’s auditors and the audit committee of the registrant’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions): a) b) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the registrant’s ability to record, process, summarize, and report financial information; and Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the registrant’s internal control over financial reporting. Date: February 20, 2024 /s/ KEITH PFEIL Keith Pfeil Chief Financial Officer and Chief Operating Officer Chief Accounting Officer Senior Vice President (Principal Financial Officer) Certification Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as Adopted Pursuant to Section 906 of The Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 EXHIBIT 32 Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the United States Code), Daniel T. Scavilla, Chief Executive Officer, and Keith Pfeil, Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer of Globus Medical, Inc. (the “Company”), each certifies with respect to the Annual Report of the Company on Form 10-K for the period ended December 31, 2023 (the “Report”) that, to the best of his knowledge: (1) The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and (2) The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company. Date: February 20, 2024 /s/ DANIEL T. SCAVILLA Daniel T. Scavilla Chief Executive Officer President (Principal Executive Officer) Date: February 20, 2024 /s/ KEITH PFEIL Keith Pfeil Chief Financial Officer and Chief Operating Officer Chief Accounting Officer Senior Vice President (Principal Financial Officer) The foregoing certification is being furnished solely pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (Section 1350 of Chapter 63 of Title 18 of the United States Code) and is not being filed as part of the Report or as a separate disclosure document. GLOBUS MEDICAL, INC. COMPENSATION RECOUPMENT POLICY I. Purpose The Board of Directors (“Board”) of Globus Medical, Inc. (“Globus”), as recommended by this Compensation its Compensation Committee Recoupment Policy (this “Policy) as its mandatory clawback policy if a Restatement under the Applicable Rules (defined below) occurs. (“Committee”), has adopted Any capitalized terms used but not immediately defined in this Policy shall have the meanings contained in Section II. II. Defined Terms a. b. c. d. e. “Applicable Rules” means Section 10D of the Exchange Act and Rule 10D-1 promulgated thereunder, Section 303A.14 of The New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”) Listed Company Manual, applicable interpretations of these rules, and any other national stock exchange rules or interpretations to which Globus is or becomes subject. “Exchange Act” means the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended. “Financial Reporting Measures” mean (i) measures used in preparing Globus’s financial statements that are determined and presented in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles, and any measures derived in whole or in part from such measures, (ii) Globus’s stock price, and (iii) Globus’s total shareholder return. A “Financial Reporting Measure” need not be presented in the financial statements or a report filed with the SEC. “Incentive-Based Compensation” means any compensation granted, earned, paid, received, or vested, based in whole or in part on the attainment of a Financial Reporting Measure. Incentive-Based Compensation does not include, among other forms of compensation, base salary or cash bonuses or equity awards that vest exclusively upon completion of a specified employment period and are unrelated to Financial Reporting Measures. Incentive-Based Compensation is deemed to be “Received” the Financial Reporting Measure applicable to the Incentive-Based Compensation award is attained, even if the payment or grant of the Incentive-Based Compensation occurs in another fiscal period. fiscal period during which the in “Recovery Period” means the three completed fiscal years immediately before the date that Globus is required to prepare a Restatement, which date is the earlier of the date (i) the Board, a Board committee, or the officer or officers of Globus authorized to take such action if Board action is not required, conclude, or reasonably should have concluded, that Globus is required to prepare a Restatement or (ii) a court, regulator, or other legally authorized body directs Globus to prepare a Restatement. f. “Regulators” means, as applicable, the SEC and NYSE. g. h. i. “Restatement” means an accounting restatement that Globus is required to prepare due to Globus’s material noncompliance with any financial reporting requirement under the securities laws, including (i) an error in previously issued financial statements that is material to the previously issued financial statements, or (ii) an error that would result in a material misstatement if it were corrected in the current period or left uncorrected in the current period. “SEC” means the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission. “Senior Officer” means any person designated by the Board as such in accordance with the definition of executive officer set forth in the Applicable Rules. III. Administration The Committee shall administer this Policy and has the sole discretion to make all related determinations under this Policy, provided that the Committee must interpret this Policy in a manner that is consistent with the Applicable Rules. IV. Recovery on a Restatement If required to prepare a Restatement, Globus shall reasonably and promptly recover from any Senior Officer the amount, as calculated pursuant to this Section IV, of erroneously awarded Incentive-Based Compensation that was Received by such Senior Officer during the Recovery Period. The amount of erroneously awarded Incentive-Based Compensation subject to this Policy will be the excess of (i) the amount of Incentive-Based Compensation the Senior Officer Received (whether in cash or shares) based on the erroneous data in the original financial statements; over (ii) the amount of Incentive-Based Compensation (whether in cash or shares) the Senior Officer would have Received if the Incentive-Based Compensation had been based on the restated results, without respect to any tax liabilities the Senior Officer incurred or paid in respect of such Incentive-Based Compensation. Recovery of any erroneously awarded compensation under this Policy is not dependent on fraud or misconduct by any Senior Officer in connection with a Restatement. Without limiting the foregoing, for Incentive-Based Compensation based on Globus’s stock price or total shareholder return, where the amount of erroneously awarded compensation is not subject to mathematical recalculation directly from the information in the Restatement, (i) the amount shall be based on Globus’s reasonable estimate of the effect of the Restatement on the stock price or total shareholder return upon which the Incentive- Based Compensation was Received and (ii) Globus shall maintain documentation of the determination of that reasonable estimate and provide such estimate to NYSE. If a Senior Officer fails to repay or reimburse erroneously awarded compensation subject to recovery under this Policy, the Committee may require the Senior Officer to reimburse Globus for any and all expenses reasonably incurred (including legal fees) in recovering the erroneously awarded compensation. 2 V. Coverage and Application This Policy covers all Senior Officers who have Received Incentive-Based Compensation at any time during the Recovery Period. Incentive-Based Compensation shall not be recovered under this Policy if Received by any person before the effective date that such person was appointed a Senior Officer. Subsequent changes in a Senior Officer’s employment status, including retirement or termination of employment, do not affect Globus’s right or obligation to recover Incentive-Based Compensation under this Policy. This Policy shall apply to Incentive-Based Compensation Received by any Senior Officer on or after October 2, 2023 (the “NYSE Rule Effective Date”) that results from the attainment of a Financial Reporting Measure based on or derived from financial information for any fiscal period ending on or after the NYSE Rule Effective Date. This includes Incentive-Based Compensation approved, awarded, or granted to a Senior Officer on or before the NYSE Rule Effective Date, even if such Incentive-Based Compensation is Received after the NYSE Rule Effective Date. VI. Exceptions to Policy Globus shall not be required to recover Incentive-Based Compensation if any of the following conditions exist and the Committee determines that these conditions would cause recovery to be impracticable: a. c. The direct expense paid to a third party to assist in enforcing this Policy would exceed the recoverable amount; provided that before the Committee determines that recovery would be impracticable based on the expense of enforcement, Globus shall have (i) made a reasonable attempt to recover the Incentive-Based Compensation, (ii) documented such reasonable attempts to recover, and (iii) provided NYSE applicable documentation; b. Recovery would violate the home country law where that law was adopted before November 28, 2022, and the Committee has obtained an opinion of home country counsel, acceptable to NYSE, that recovery would result in such a violation, and has provided such opinion to NYSE in accordance with the Applicable Rules; or Recovery would likely cause an otherwise tax-qualified retirement plan, under which benefits are broadly available to employees, to fail to meet the requirements of Section 401(a)(13) or Section 411(a) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), and related U.S. Treasury regulations. VII. Public Disclosure Globus shall make all required disclosures and filings with the Regulators concerning this Policy consistent with the requirements of the Applicable Rules and any other applicable requirements, including any disclosures required in connection with SEC filings. VIII. Methods of Recovery In the event of a Restatement, the Committee may take any such actions as it deems necessary or appropriate, subject to applicable law, including, without limitation: 4 a. b. c. d. e. f. The reduction or cancellation of any Incentive-Based Compensation in the form of vested or unvested equity or equity-based awards that have not been distributed or otherwise settled before the date of determination; The recovery of any Incentive-Based Compensation previously paid to the Senior Officer; The recovery of any gain realized on the vesting, exercise, settlement, sale, transfer, or other disposition of any Incentive-Based Compensation in the form of equity or equity-based awards; The offset, withholding, or elimination of any amount that could be paid or awarded to the Senior Officer after the date of determination; The recoupment of any amount of Incentive-Based Compensation contributed to a plan that takes into account Incentive-Based Compensation (excluding certain tax- qualified plans, but including long-term disability, life insurance, supplemental executive retirement plans and deferred compensation plans, in each case to the extent permitted by applicable law, including Section 409A of the Code) and any earnings accrued to date on any such amount; and The taking of any other remedial and recovery action permitted by law that the Committee determines. The Committee also may authorize legal action for breach of fiduciary duty or other violation of law and take such other actions to enforce the Senior Officer’s obligations to Globus as the Committee deems appropriate. IX. No Indemnification Globus shall not indemnify any current or former Senior Officer against the loss of erroneously awarded compensation and shall not pay or reimburse any Senior Officer for premiums incurred or paid for any insurance policy to fund such Senior Officer’s potential recovery obligations. X. Administrator Indemnification The Committee, and any other members of the Board who assist in the administration of this Policy, shall not be personally liable for any action, determination or interpretation made with respect to this Policy and shall be fully indemnified by Globus to the fullest extent under applicable law and Globus policy with respect to any such action, determination or interpretation. The foregoing sentence shall not limit any other rights to indemnification of the Committee or members of the Board under applicable law, Globus’s Certificate of Incorporation and Bylaws (as each may be amended from time to time), or any contractual rights. 6 XI. No Substitution of Rights; Non-Exhaustive Rights Any right of recoupment under this Policy is additive and does not replace any other remedies or rights of recoupment that may be available to Globus under (a) the Globus 2021 Equity Incentive Plan, as amended, and any other incentive plan of Globus or any of its subsidiaries or affiliates, or any amendments or successor plans thereto and (b) the terms of any similar policy or provision in any equity award agreement, employment agreement, compensation agreement or arrangement, or similar agreement and any other legal remedies available to Globus. In addition to recovery of compensation as provided for in this Policy, Globus may take any and all other actions as it deems necessary, appropriate, and in Globus’s best interest in connection with a Restatement, including termination of a Senior Officer’s employment and initiating legal action against a Senior Officer. Nothing in this Policy limits Globus’s rights to take any such or other appropriate actions. XII. Amendment The Board, on the Committee’s recommendation, may amend this Policy at any time for any reason, subject to any limitations under the Applicable Rules. The Board may terminate this Policy whenever the Applicable Rules no longer apply to Globus. XIII. Successors This Policy shall be binding and enforceable against all Senior Officers, their beneficiaries, heirs, executors, administrators, or other legal representatives. XIV. Effective Date of Policy This Policy shall be effective as of December 1, 2023 (the “Policy Effective Date”). The terms of this Policy shall apply to any Incentive-Based Compensation Received by any Senior Officer on or after the NYSE Rule Effective Date, even if such Incentive-Based Compensation was approved, awarded, granted, or paid to such Senior Officer before the Policy Effective Date. Without limiting the generality of Section VIII, and subject to applicable law, the Committee may effect recovery under this Policy from any amount of compensation approved, awarded, granted, payable, or paid to any Senior Officer prior to, on, or after the Policy Effective Date. 8

Continue reading text version or see original annual report in PDF format above